blob: 776fd70640ee0697bb52f592d838f8029104a3d5 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau71f95fa2020-01-22 10:34:58 +01007 2020/01/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - presetenv
615 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - uid
617 - ulimit-n
618 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200619 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100620 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200621 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-options
625 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-options
628 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100629 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200672 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200673 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200674 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100675 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200676 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200677 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100678 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100679 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100680 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.session-timeout
682 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200683 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100684 - tune.maxaccept
685 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200686 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200687 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200688 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100689 - tune.rcvbuf.client
690 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100691 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200692 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.sndbuf.client
694 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100695 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100696 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200697 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100698 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200699 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200700 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100701 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200702 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100703 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200704 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
705 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
706 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100707 - tune.zlib.memlevel
708 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 * Debugging
711 - debug
712 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713
714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716------------------------------------
717
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200718ca-base <dir>
719 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200720 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
721 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723chroot <jail dir>
724 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
725 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
726 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
727 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
728 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100730
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
732 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
733 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
734 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
735 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
736 set. These sets have the format
737
738 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
739
740 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
743 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100744 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
745 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100747 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
751 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
752 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
753 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100754
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100755 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
756 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
757 on the machine's word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
761 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
762 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
763 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
764 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
765 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100766
767 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
769
770 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
771 # first 4 CPUs
772
773 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
774 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
775 # word size.
776
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
784 # and so on.
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100789 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
791 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
792 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
793
794 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
795 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
797
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100798 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
799 # and a thread range.
800 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
803
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200804crt-base <dir>
805 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100806 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
807 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200809daemon
810 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
811 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100812 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
813 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815deviceatlas-json-file <path>
816 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100817 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200818
819deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100820 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
822
823deviceatlas-separator <char>
824 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
825 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
826
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100827deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200828 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
829 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
830 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100831
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900832external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100833 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
834 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100835 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
836 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
837 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
838 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
839 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841gid <number>
842 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
843 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
844 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100845 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
846 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100848
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100849group <group name>
850 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
851 See also "gid" and "user".
852
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100853hard-stop-after <time>
854 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
855
856 Arguments :
857 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
858 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
859 SIGUSR1 signal.
860
861 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
862 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
863 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
864
865 Example:
866 global
867 hard-stop-after 30s
868
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200869h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
870 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
871 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
872 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
873 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
874 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
875 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
876 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
877 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
878 specified in a proxy.
879
880 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
881 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
882 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
883 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
884 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
885 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
886 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
887
888 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
889 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
890 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
891 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
892 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
893
894 Example:
895 global
896 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
897
898 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
899 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
900
901h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
902 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
903 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
904 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
905 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
906 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
907 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
908 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
909 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
910
911 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
912 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
913 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
914
915 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
916 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
917
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100918insecure-fork-wanted
919 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
920 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
921 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
922 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
923 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
924 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
925 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
926 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
927 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
928 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
929 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
930 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
931 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
932 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
933 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
934 disable it.
935
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100936insecure-setuid-wanted
937 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
938 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
939 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
940 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
941 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
942 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
943 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
944 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
945 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
946 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
947 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
948 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
949 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
950 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
951
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200952log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
953 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100954 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100955 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100956 configured with "log global".
957
958 <address> can be one of:
959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100960 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100961 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
962 port).
963
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100964 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
965 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
966 port).
967
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100968 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100969 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
970 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100972
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100973 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
974 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
975 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
976 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
977 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
978 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
979 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
980 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
981 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
982 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
983 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
984 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
985 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
986 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100987 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
988 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100989
990 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
991 "fd@2", see above.
992
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200993 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
994 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
995 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
996 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
997 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
998
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200999 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1000 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001001
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001002 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1003 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1004 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1005 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1006 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1007 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1008 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1009 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1010 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1011 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001012 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1013 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001014
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001015 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1016 one of the following :
1017
1018 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1019 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1020
1021 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1022 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1023
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001024 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1025 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1026 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1027 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1028 logger consumes.
1029
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001030 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1031 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1032 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1033 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1034
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001035 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1036 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1037 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1038 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1039 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1040
1041 <sample_size>
1042 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1043 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1044 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1045 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1046 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1047
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001048 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001050 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1051 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1052 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1053
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001054 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1055 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1056 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1057 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058
1059 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001060 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1061 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1062 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1063 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1064 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1065 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001067 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001069log-send-hostname [<string>]
1070 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1071 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1072 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1073 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1074 the logs.
1075
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001076log-tag <string>
1077 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1078 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1079 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001080 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001081
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082lua-load <file>
1083 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1084 used multiple times.
1085
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001086lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1087 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1088 variable.
1089 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1090 to "path".
1091
1092 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1093 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1094 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1095 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1096 will be checked earlier.
1097
1098 As an example by specifying the following path:
1099
1100 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1101 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1102
1103 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1104 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1105 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1106 paths if that does not exist either.
1107
1108 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1109 documentation.
1110
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001111master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001112 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1113 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1114 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001115 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001116 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1117 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001118 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1119 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1120 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1121 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1122 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001123
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001124 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001125
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001126mworker-max-reloads <number>
1127 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001128 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001129 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1130 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1131 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133nbproc <number>
1134 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1135 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1136 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001137 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1138 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001139 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1140 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001142nbthread <number>
1143 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001144 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1145 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1146 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1147 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1148 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001149 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1150 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1151 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1152 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1153 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1154 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1155 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001156
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001158 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1160 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162presetenv <name> <value>
1163 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1164 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1165 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1166 and "unsetenv".
1167
1168resetenv [<name> ...]
1169 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1170 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1171 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1172 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1173 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1174 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1175 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1176 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1177
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001178stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001179 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1180 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1181 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1182 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1183 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1184 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001185 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001186 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1187 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1188 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1189 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001190
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001191server-state-base <directory>
1192 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001193 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1194 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001195
1196server-state-file <file>
1197 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1198 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1199 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1200 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1201 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1202 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1203 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1204 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001205 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1206 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001207
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001208setenv <name> <value>
1209 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1210 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1211 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1212 and "unsetenv".
1213
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001214set-dumpable
1215 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001216 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1217 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1218 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1219 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1220 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1221 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1222 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1223 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1224 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1225 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1226 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1227 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1228 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1229 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1230 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1231 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1232 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001234ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1236 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001237 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001238 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001239 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1240 information and recommendations see e.g.
1241 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1242 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1243 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1244 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001245
1246ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1248 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1249 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1250 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1251 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001252 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1253 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1254 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001255 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001256
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001257ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1259 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1260 keyword to see available options.
1261
1262 Example:
1263 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001264 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001265
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001266ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1268 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001269 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001270 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1272 information and recommendations see e.g.
1273 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1274 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1275 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1276 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1277 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001278
1279ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1281 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1282 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1283 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1284 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1286 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1287 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1288 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001289
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1292 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1293 keyword to see available options.
1294
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1298 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001299 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001300 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001301 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1302 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1303 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1304 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001305 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1306 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1307 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1308
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001309ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer>*
1310 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1311 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1312
1313 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1314 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1315 optimize the startup time.
1316
1317 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1318 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1319 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1320
1321 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
1322 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer.
1323
1324 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1325 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1326 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1327 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1328 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1329 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
1330 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specifiy both the ECDSA
1331 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1332
1333 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1334
1335 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1336
1337 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1338 not provided in the PEM file.
1339
1340 The default behavior is "all".
1341
1342 Example:
1343 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1344 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1345 ssl-load-extra-files none
1346
1347 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1348
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001349ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1350 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1351 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1352 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1353
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001354stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1355 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1356 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1357 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001358 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001359 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001360
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001361 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1362 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1363 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001364
1365stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1366 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1367 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001368 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001369
1370stats maxconn <connections>
1371 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1372 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1373
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001374uid <number>
1375 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1376 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1377 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1378 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1379
1380ulimit-n <number>
1381 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1382 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1383 option.
1384
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001385unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1386 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1387
1388 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1389 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1390 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1391 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1392 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1393 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1394 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1395 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1396 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1397 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1398
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001399unsetenv [<name> ...]
1400 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1401 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1402 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1403 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1404 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1405 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1406 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1407
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001408user <user name>
1409 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1410 See also "uid" and "group".
1411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001412node <name>
1413 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1414
1415 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1416 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1417 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1418 traffic.
1419
1420description <text>
1421 Add a text that describes the instance.
1422
1423 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1424 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1425 "<" and ">" characters.
1426
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100142751degrees-data-file <file path>
1428 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001429 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001430
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001431 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001432 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1433
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000143451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001435 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1436 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1437 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1438
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001439 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001440 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1441
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200144251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001443 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1444 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1445
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001446 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1447 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1448
144951degrees-cache-size <number>
1450 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1451 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1452 By default, this cache is disabled.
1453
1454 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001455 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1456
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001457wurfl-data-file <file path>
1458 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1459 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1460
1461 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1462 with USE_WURFL=1.
1463
1464wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1465 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1466 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1467 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1468
1469 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1470
1471 Valid WURFL properties are:
1472 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1473
1474 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1475 device.
1476
1477 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1478 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1479
1480 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1481 particular web request.
1482
1483 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1484 used Libwurfl API version.
1485
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001486 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1487 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1488
1489 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1490 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1491
1492 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1493
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001494 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1495 with USE_WURFL=1.
1496
1497wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1498 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1499 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1500
1501 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1502 with USE_WURFL=1.
1503
1504wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1505 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1506 thus before the chroot.
1507
1508 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1509 with USE_WURFL=1.
1510
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001511wurfl-cache-size <size>
1512 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1513 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001514 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001515 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001516
1517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1518 with USE_WURFL=1.
1519
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001520strict-limits
1521 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1522 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1523 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1524 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1525 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1526 keyword.
1527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015283.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529-----------------------
1530
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001531busy-polling
1532 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1533 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1534 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1535 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1536 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1537 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1538 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1539 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1540 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1541 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1542 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1543 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1544 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1545 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1546 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1547 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1548 "poll" pollers.
1549
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001550 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1551 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1552 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1553
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001554max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1555 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1556 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1557 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1558 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1559 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1560 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1561 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1562 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001564maxconn <number>
1565 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1566 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1567 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001568 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1569 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1570 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1571 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001572 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1573 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1574 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1575 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1576 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1577 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001579maxconnrate <number>
1580 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1581 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1582 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1583 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1584 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1585 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1586 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1587 fairness.
1588
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001589maxcomprate <number>
1590 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001591 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001592 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1593 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1594 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001595 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001596 default value.
1597
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001598maxcompcpuusage <number>
1599 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1600 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1601 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1602 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1603 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1604 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1605 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1606 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1607
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001608maxpipes <number>
1609 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1610 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1611 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1612 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1613 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1614 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1615
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001616maxsessrate <number>
1617 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1618 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1619 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1620 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1621 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1622 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1623 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1624 fairness.
1625
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001626maxsslconn <number>
1627 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1628 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1629 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1630 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1631 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1632 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1633 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001634 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1635 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1636 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1637 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1638 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1639 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1640 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001641
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001642maxsslrate <number>
1643 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1644 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1645 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1646 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1647 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1648 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1649 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1650 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1651 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1652 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1653
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001654maxzlibmem <number>
1655 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1656 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1657 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001658 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1659 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1660 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001662noepoll
1663 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1664 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001665 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001666
1667nokqueue
1668 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1669 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1670 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1671
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001672noevports
1673 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1674 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1675 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1676 also "nopoll".
1677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001678nopoll
1679 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1680 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001682 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1683 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001684
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001685nosplice
1686 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001688 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001689 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001690 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1691 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1692 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1693 "option splice-response".
1694
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001695nogetaddrinfo
1696 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1697 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1698
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001699noreuseport
1700 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1701 command line argument "-dR".
1702
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001703profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1704 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1705 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1706 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1707 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001708 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001709 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1710 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1711 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1712 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1713
1714 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1715 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1716 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1717 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1718 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001719 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1720 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1721 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1722 CLI.
1723
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001724spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001725 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1726 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1727 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1728 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1729 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1730 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001731
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001732ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001733 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001735 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1736 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1737 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1738 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1739 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1741 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001742 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1743 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1744 openssl configuration file uses:
1745 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1746
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001747ssl-mode-async
1748 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001749 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001750 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1751 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1752 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001753 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001754 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001755
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001756tune.buffers.limit <number>
1757 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1758 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1759 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1760 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1761 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001763 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1764 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1765 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1766 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1767 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1768 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1769 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1770 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1771 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1772
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001773tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1774 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1775 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1776 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1777 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1778
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001779tune.bufsize <number>
1780 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1781 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1782 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1783 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1784 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1785 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1786 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001787 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1788 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1789 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001790 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001791 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1792 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1793 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001794
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001795tune.chksize <number>
1796 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1797 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1798 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1799 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1800 checks whenever possible.
1801
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001802tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1803 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1804 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1805 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1806 this value. The default value is 1.
1807
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001808tune.fail-alloc
1809 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1810 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1811 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1812 gracefully.
1813
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001814tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1815 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1816 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1817 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1818 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1819 change it.
1820
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001821tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1822 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1824 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001825 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1826 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1827 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1828 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1829 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1830
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001831tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1832 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1833 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1834 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1835 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1836 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1837 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1838 recommended not to change this value.
1839
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001840tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1841 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1842 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1843 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1844 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1845 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1846 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1847 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1848
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001849tune.http.cookielen <number>
1850 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1851 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1852 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1853 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1854 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1855 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1856 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1857 to change this value.
1858
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001859tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1861 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001862 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001863 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001864 configuration directives too.
1865 The default value is 1024.
1866
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001867tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1868 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1869 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1870 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1871 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1872 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1873 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001874 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1875 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1876 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001877
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001878tune.idletimer <timeout>
1879 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1880 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1881 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1882 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1883 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1884 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001885 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001886 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001887 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1888
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001889tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1890 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1891 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1892 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1893 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1894 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1895 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1896 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1897 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1898 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1899
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001900tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1901 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001902 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001903 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1904 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001905 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001906 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1907 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1908
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001909tune.lua.maxmem
1910 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1911 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1912 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1913 memory.
1914
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001915tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1916 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001917 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1918 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001920
1921tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1922 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1923 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1924 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1925 check servers.
1926
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001927tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1928 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1929 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1930 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001932
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001933tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001934 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1935 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1936 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1937 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1938 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1939 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1940 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1941 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1942 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1943 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001944
1945tune.maxpollevents <number>
1946 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1947 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1948 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1949 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1950 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1951
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001952tune.maxrewrite <number>
1953 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1954 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1955 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1956 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1957 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1958 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1959 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1960 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1961 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1962 bufsize.
1963
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001964tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1965 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1966 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1967 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1968 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1969 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1970 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1971 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1972 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1973 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001974 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1975 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001976 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1977 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1978 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1979 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1980 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1981 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1982 setting this parameter to 0.
1983
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001984tune.pipesize <number>
1985 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1986 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1987 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1988 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1989 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1990 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1991
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001992tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1993 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1994 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1995 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1996 default is 20.
1997
1998tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1999 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2000 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2001 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2002 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2003 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2004 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002005 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002006
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002007tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2008tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2009 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2010 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2011 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002012 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002013 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002014 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2015 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2016
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002017tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002018 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002019 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2020 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2021 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2022 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2023
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002024tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002025 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002026 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2027 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2028
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002029tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2030tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2031 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2032 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2033 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002034 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002035 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002036 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2037 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2038 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2039 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2040 notifying haproxy again.
2041
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002042tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002043 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2044 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2045 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002046 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002047 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002048 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002049 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2050 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2051 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002052 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2053 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002054
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002055tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002056 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002057 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2058 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2059 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2060 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2061 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2062
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002063tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2064 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002066 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2067 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2068 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2069 being used for too long.
2070
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002071tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2072 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2073 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2074 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2075 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2076 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2077 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2078 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2079 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2080 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2081 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002082 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002083 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002084
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002085tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2086 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2087 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2088 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2089 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2090 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2091 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2092 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002093 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2094 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002095
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002096tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2097 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2098 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2099 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2100 1000 entries.
2101
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002102tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2103 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2104 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2105 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002107tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002108tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002109tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2110tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2111tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002112 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2113 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2114 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2115 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2116 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2117 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2118 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2119 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002120
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002121 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2122 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2123 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2124 all available space is consumed.
2125 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2126 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2127 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002128
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002129tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2130 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002131 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002132 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002133 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002134 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2135
2136tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2137 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2138 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2140 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021423.3. Debugging
2143--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002144
2145debug
2146 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2147 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2148 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2149 system startup.
2150
2151quiet
2152 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2153 line argument "-q".
2154
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021563.4. Userlists
2157--------------
2158It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2159http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2160it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2161
2162userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002163 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002164 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2165
2166group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002167 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002168 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2169 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2170
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002171user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2172 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002173 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2174 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002175 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2176 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2177 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2178 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002179
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002180 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2181 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2182 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2183 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2184 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2185 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2186 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2187 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2188 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002189
2190 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002191 userlist L1
2192 group G1 users tiger,scott
2193 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002194
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002195 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2196 user scott insecure-password elgato
2197 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199 userlist L2
2200 group G1
2201 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002202
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002203 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2204 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2205 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002206
2207 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002208
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002209
22103.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002211----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002212It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2213several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2214instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2215values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2216automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2217In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2218using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2219tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2220reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2221Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2222that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2223each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002224
2225peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002226 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002227 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2228
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002229bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2230 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2231 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2232
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002233disabled
2234 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2235 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2236 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2237
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002238default-bind [param*]
2239 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2240
2241default-server [param*]
2242 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2243
2244 Arguments:
2245 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2246 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2247 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2248 details.
2249
2250
2251 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2252
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002253enable
2254 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2255
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002256log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2257 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2258 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2259 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2260 more details.
2261
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002262peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002263 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2264 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2265 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2266 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2267 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2268 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2269
2270 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2271 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2272
2273 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2274 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2275 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2276 across all peers.
2277
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002278 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2279 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002280
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002281 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2282 "server" keyword explanation below).
2283
2284server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002285 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002286 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2287 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2288 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2289 of this "peers" section).
2290 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2291
2292
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002293 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002294 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002295 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002296 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2297 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2298 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002299
2300 backend mybackend
2301 mode tcp
2302 balance roundrobin
2303 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2304 stick on src
2305
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002306 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2307 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309 Example:
2310 peers mypeers
2311 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2312 default-server ssl verify none
2313 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2314 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002315
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002316
2317table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2318 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2319
2320 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2321 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002322 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002323 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2324 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2325 "stick-table" keyword).
2326
2327 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2328 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2329 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2330 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2331 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2332 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2333 of the stick-table name as follows:
2334
2335 peers mypeers
2336 peer A ...
2337 peer B ...
2338 table t1 ...
2339
2340 frontend fe1
2341 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2342
2343 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2344 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2345
2346 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2347 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2348 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2349 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2350 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2351 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2352 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2353
2354 peers mypeers
2355 peer A ...
2356 peer B ...
2357 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2358
2359 backend t1
2360 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2361
2362 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2363 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2364 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2365
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023663.6. Mailers
2367------------
2368It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2369If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2370in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2371
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002372mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002373 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2374 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2375
2376mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2377 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2378
2379 Example:
2380 mailers mymailers
2381 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2382 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2383
2384 backend mybackend
2385 mode tcp
2386 balance roundrobin
2387
2388 email-alert mailers mymailers
2389 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2390 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2391
2392 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2393 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2394
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002395timeout mail <time>
2396 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2397 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2398 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2399 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2400
2401 Example:
2402 mailers mymailers
2403 timeout mail 20s
2404 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002405
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024063.7. Programs
2407-------------
2408In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2409master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2410managed the same way as the workers.
2411
2412During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2413sequence as a worker:
2414
2415 - the master is re-executed
2416 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2417 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2418 instance of the program
2419
2420During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2421
2422program <name>
2423 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2424 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2425 the management guide).
2426
2427command <command> [arguments*]
2428 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2429 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2430 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2431 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2432
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002433user <user name>
2434 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2435 See also "group".
2436
2437group <group name>
2438 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2439 See also "user".
2440
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002441option start-on-reload
2442no option start-on-reload
2443 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2444 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2445 program section.
2446
2447
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024483.8. HTTP-errors
2449----------------
2450
2451It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2452imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2453several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2454
2455http-errors <name>
2456 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2457 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2458
2459errorfile <code> <file>
2460 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2461
2462 Arguments :
2463 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2464 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2465 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2466
2467 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2468 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2469 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2470 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2471 before any chroot is performed.
2472
2473 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2474
2475 Example:
2476 http-errors website-1
2477 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2478 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2479 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2480
2481 http-errors website-2
2482 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2483 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2484 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2485
2486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002488----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002490Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002491 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002492 - frontend <name>
2493 - backend <name>
2494 - listen <name>
2495
2496A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2497its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2498section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002500
2501A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2502connections.
2503
2504A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2505to forward incoming connections.
2506
2507A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2508parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2511'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2512case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2513
2514Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2515logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2516proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2517However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2518name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2519
2520Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2521and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002522bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2524modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2525arbitrary criteria.
2526
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002527In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2528a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002529the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002530
2531 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2532 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2533 between responses and new requests.
2534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002535 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2536 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2537 client-facing connection remains open.
2538
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002539 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2540 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002541
2542The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2543frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2544following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002545weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002546
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002547 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002548
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002549 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2550 ----+-----+-----+----
2551 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2552 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002553 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2554 ----+-----+-----+----
2555 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2560--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002562The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2563limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2564they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2565limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002566marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002567option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002568and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2569with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2570specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002572
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002573 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2574------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2575acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576backlog X X X -
2577balance X - X X
2578bind - X X -
2579bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580capture cookie - X X -
2581capture request header - X X -
2582capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002583compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002584cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002585declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586default-server X - X X
2587default_backend X X X -
2588description - X X X
2589disabled X X X X
2590dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002591email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002592email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002593email-alert mailers X X X X
2594email-alert myhostname X X X X
2595email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002596enabled X X X X
2597errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002598errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002599errorloc X X X X
2600errorloc302 X X X X
2601-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2602errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002603force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002604filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002605fullconn X - X X
2606grace X X X X
2607hash-type X - X X
2608http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002609http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002610http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002611http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002612http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002613http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002614http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002615id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002616ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002617load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002618log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002619log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002620log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002621log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002622max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623maxconn X X X -
2624mode X X X X
2625monitor fail - X X -
2626monitor-net X X X -
2627monitor-uri X X X -
2628option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2629option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2630option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2631option allbackups (*) X - X X
2632option checkcache (*) X - X X
2633option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2634option contstats (*) X X X -
2635option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2636option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002637-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2638option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002639option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2640option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002641option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002642option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002643option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002644option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002645option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2647option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2648option httpchk X - X X
2649option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002650option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002652option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002653option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002654option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2656option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2657option logasap (*) X X X -
2658option mysql-check X - X X
2659option nolinger (*) X X X X
2660option originalto X X X X
2661option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002662option pgsql-check X - X X
2663option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002664option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002665option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666option smtpchk X - X X
2667option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2668option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2669option splice-request (*) X X X X
2670option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002671option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002672option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2673option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2674-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002675option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002676option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2677option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2678option tcpka X X X X
2679option tcplog X X X X
2680option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002681external-check command X - X X
2682external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002683persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2684rate-limit sessions X X X -
2685redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002686-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002687retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002688retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002689server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002690server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002691server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002692source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002693stats admin - X X X
2694stats auth X X X X
2695stats enable X X X X
2696stats hide-version X X X X
2697stats http-request - X X X
2698stats realm X X X X
2699stats refresh X X X X
2700stats scope X X X X
2701stats show-desc X X X X
2702stats show-legends X X X X
2703stats show-node X X X X
2704stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002705-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2706stick match - - X X
2707stick on - - X X
2708stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002709stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002710stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002711tcp-check connect - - X X
2712tcp-check expect - - X X
2713tcp-check send - - X X
2714tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002715tcp-request connection - X X -
2716tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002717tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002718tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002719tcp-response content - - X X
2720tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002721timeout check X - X X
2722timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002723timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002724timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002725timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2726timeout http-request X X X X
2727timeout queue X - X X
2728timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002729timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002730timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002731timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002732transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002733unique-id-format X X X -
2734unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002736use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002737use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2739 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027424.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2743---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744
2745This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2746
2747
2748acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2749 Declare or complete an access list.
2750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2751 no | yes | yes | yes
2752 Example:
2753 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2754 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2755 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002757 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758
2759
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002760backlog <conns>
2761 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2763 yes | yes | yes | no
2764 Arguments :
2765 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2766 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002767 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002768
2769 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2770 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2771 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2772 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2773 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2774 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2775 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2776 backlog parameter.
2777
2778 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2779 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2780 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2781
2782 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2783
2784
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002785balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002786balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2789 yes | no | yes | yes
2790 Arguments :
2791 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2792 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2793 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2794 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2795
2796 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2797 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2798 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2799 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002800 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002801 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002802 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2803 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2804 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2805 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2806 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2807 it, so that you don't worry.
2808
2809 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2810 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2811 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2812 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2813 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2814 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2815 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2816 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002818 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2819 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2820 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2821 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2822 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2823 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2824 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2825 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2826
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002827 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002828 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002829 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2830 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002831 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002832 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2833 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2834 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2835 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2836 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002837 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2838 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2839 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2840 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2841 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2842 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002844 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2845 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2846 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2847 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2848 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2849 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2850 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2851 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002853 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002854 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2855 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2856 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002858 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2859 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2860 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2861 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2862 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2863 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2864 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2865 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2866 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2867 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2868 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2869 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002871 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002872 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2873 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2874 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2875 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2876 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2877 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2878 URIs start with a leading "/".
2879
2880 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2881 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2882 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2883 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002886 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2887
2888 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002889 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2890 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002891 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2892 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2893 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2894 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002895 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002896 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2897 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002898
2899 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2900 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2901 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2902 server will receive the request.
2903
2904 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2905 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2906 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2907 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2908 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002909 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2910 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2911 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002913 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2914 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2915 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2916 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2917 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002919 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002920 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2921 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2922 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2923
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002924 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2925 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2926 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2927
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002928 random
2929 random(<draws>)
2930 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002931 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2932 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2933 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2934 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002935 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2936 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2937 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2938 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2939 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2940 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2941 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2942 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2943 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2944 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2945 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2946 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2947 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2948 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2949 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2950 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2951 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2952 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2953 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2954 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002955
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002956 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002957 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002958 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2959 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2960 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2961 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2962 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2963 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002964 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002965 used instead.
2966
2967 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2968 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2969 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2970 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2971
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002972 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2973 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2974 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2975
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002976 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002977
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002979 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2980 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002981
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002982 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2983 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2984 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002986 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002987 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002988 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2989 NTLM relies on.
2990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002991 Examples :
2992 balance roundrobin
2993 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002994 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002995 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2996 balance hdr(host)
2997 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002998
2999 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3000 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003002 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003003 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3004 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3005 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003006 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003007
3008 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3009 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3010 defaults to 16 kB.
3011
3012 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3013 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3014
3015 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3016 Round Robin.
3017
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003018 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003019 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3020 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3021 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3022
3023 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3024
3025 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003026 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003027 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3028 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3029 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003031 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032
3033
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003034bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3035bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3038 no | yes | yes | no
3039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003040 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3041 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3042 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3043 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003044 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003045 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3046 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3047 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3048 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3049 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3050 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3051 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003052 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3053 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3054 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3055 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3056 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3057 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3058 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003059 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3060 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3061 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003062 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3063 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3064 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3065 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003066 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3067 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3068 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003069
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003070 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3071 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003072 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3073 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3074 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003075 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3076 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3077 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3078 the range.
3079
3080 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3081 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3082 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3083 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3084 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3085 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3086 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003087 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003088 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003090 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003091 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003092 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3093 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3094 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3095 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3096 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3097 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3098
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003099 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3100 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3101 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3102 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3105 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3106 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3107 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3108 in a frontend.
3109
3110 Example :
3111 listen http_proxy
3112 bind :80,:443
3113 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003114 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003116 listen http_https_proxy
3117 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003118 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003119
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003120 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3121 bind ipv6@:80
3122 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3123 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3124
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003125 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003126 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003127
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003128 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3129 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3130 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3131 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3132 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3133
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003134 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003135 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136
3137
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003138bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003139 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3141 yes | yes | yes | yes
3142 Arguments :
3143 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3144 may be used to override a default value.
3145
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003146 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003147 option may be combined with other numbers.
3148
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003149 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003150 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3151 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3152 missing from all processes.
3153
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003154 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003155 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003156 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3157 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3158 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3159 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3160 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003161 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003162
3163 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3164 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3165 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3166 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3167 and 'even' instances.
3168
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003169 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3170 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3171 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3172 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003173
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003174 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3175 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3176
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003177 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3178 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3179 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3180
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003181 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3182 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3183
3184 Example :
3185 listen app_ip1
3186 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003187 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003188
3189 listen app_ip2
3190 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003191 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003192
3193 listen management
3194 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003195 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003196
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003197 listen management
3198 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3199 bind-process 1-4
3200
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003201 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003202
3203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204capture cookie <name> len <length>
3205 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 no | yes | yes | no
3208 Arguments :
3209 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3210 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3211 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3212 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003213 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003214
3215 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3216 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3217 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3218 right if it exceeds <length>.
3219
3220 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3221 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3222 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3223 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3224
3225 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3226 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3227 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3228
3229 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3230 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3231 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003232 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3233 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3234 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235
3236 Example:
3237 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3238
3239 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003240 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241
3242
3243capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003244 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3246 no | yes | yes | no
3247 Arguments :
3248 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003249 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003250 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3251 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3252 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3253
3254 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3255 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3256 it exceeds <length>.
3257
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003258 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3260 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003261 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3262 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3263 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3264 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003265 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003266 environments to find where the request came from.
3267
3268 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3269 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3270 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3271 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003272
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003273 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3274 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3275 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3276 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3277 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278
3279 Example:
3280 capture request header Host len 15
3281 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003282 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003284 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285 about logging.
3286
3287
3288capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003289 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3291 no | yes | yes | no
3292 Arguments :
3293 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003294 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3296 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3297 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3298
3299 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3300 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3301 it exceeds <length>.
3302
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003303 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003304 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3305 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3306 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003307 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3308 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3309 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3310 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003312 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3313 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3314 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3315 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3316 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
3318 Example:
3319 capture response header Content-length len 9
3320 capture response header Location len 15
3321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003322 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323 about logging.
3324
3325
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003326compression algo <algorithm> ...
3327compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003328compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003329 Enable HTTP compression.
3330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3331 yes | yes | yes | yes
3332 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003333 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3334 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3335 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3336
3337 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003338 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3339 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3340 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003341
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003342 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003343 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003344
3345 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3346 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3347 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3348 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3349 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003350 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003351
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003352 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3353 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3354 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3355 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3356 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3357 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3358 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003359 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003360
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003361 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003362 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003363 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3364 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3365 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3366 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3367 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003368
3369 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3370 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3371 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3372 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3373 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003374 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3375 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3376 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3377 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3378 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003379 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3380 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003381
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003382 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003383 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3384 "Accept-Encoding" header
3385 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003386 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003387 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3388 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3389 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3390 "multipart"
3391 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3392 header
3393 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3394 and later
3395 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3396 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003397 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003398
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003399 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003400
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003401 Examples :
3402 compression algo gzip
3403 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003405
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003406cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003407 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3408 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003409 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003410 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 yes | no | yes | yes
3413 Arguments :
3414 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3415 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3416 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3417 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3418 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3419 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003420 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003421 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3422 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3423
3424 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3425 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3426 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3427 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3428 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3429 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003430 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3431 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003432 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003433 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3434 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003435
3436 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003437 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003438
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003439 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003440 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003441 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003442 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003443 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3444 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3445 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3446 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3447 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3448 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3449 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450
3451 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3452 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3453 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3454 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3455 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3456 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3457 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3458 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3459 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003460 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003461 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3462 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3463 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003464
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003465 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3466 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3467 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003468 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3469 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3470 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3471 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003472 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3473 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3474 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003475
3476 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3477 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3478 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3479 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3480 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3481 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3482 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3483 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3484 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3485
3486 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3487 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3488 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3489 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3490 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3491 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3492 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3493 persistence cookie in the cache.
3494 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3495
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003496 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3497 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3498 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3499 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3500 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003501 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003502 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3503 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3504 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3505 they logout.
3506
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003507 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3508 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3509 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3510 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3511
3512 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3513 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3514 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3515 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3516 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3517 this attribute.
3518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003519 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003520 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003521 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3522 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3523 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3524 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3525 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3526 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003527
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003528 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3529 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3530 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3531 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3532 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3533 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3534 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3535 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003536 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003537 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3538 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3539 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3540 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3541 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3542 the site.
3543
3544 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3545 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3546 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3547 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3548 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3549 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3550 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3551 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3552 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3553 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3554 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3555 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3556 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003557 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003558 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3559 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3560
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003561 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3562 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3563 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3564 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3565 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3566 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3567
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003568 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3569 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3570 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3571 repeated.
3572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3574 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3575 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3576 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578 Examples :
3579 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3580 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3581 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003582 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003583
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003584 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003586
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003587declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3588 Declares a capture slot.
3589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 no | yes | yes | no
3591 Arguments:
3592 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3593
3594 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3595 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3596 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3597 for use in the response.
3598
3599 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003600 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003601 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3602
3603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003604default-server [param*]
3605 Change default options for a server in a backend
3606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3607 yes | no | yes | yes
3608 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003609 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3610 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3611 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3612 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003613
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003614 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003615 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3616
3617 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003618
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620default_backend <backend>
3621 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3623 yes | yes | yes | no
3624 Arguments :
3625 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3626
3627 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3628 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3629 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3630 will catch all undetermined requests.
3631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632 Example :
3633
3634 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3635 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3636 default_backend dynamic
3637
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003638 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003641description <string>
3642 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3644 no | yes | yes | yes
3645 Arguments : string
3646
3647 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3648 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3649 it describes.
3650 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3651
3652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003653disabled
3654 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | yes | yes | yes
3657 Arguments : none
3658
3659 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3660 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3661 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3662 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3663 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3664 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3665 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3666
3667 See also : "enabled"
3668
3669
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003670dispatch <address>:<port>
3671 Set a default server address
3672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003674 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003675
3676 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3677 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3678 during start-up.
3679
3680 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3681 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3682 possible with normal servers.
3683
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003684 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003685 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3686 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3687 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3688 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3689
3690 See also : "server"
3691
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003692
3693dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3694 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3696 yes | no | yes | yes
3697 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3698
3699 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003700 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003701 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3702 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003703 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003704 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003706enabled
3707 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3709 yes | yes | yes | yes
3710 Arguments : none
3711
3712 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3713 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3714
3715 See also : "disabled"
3716
3717
3718errorfile <code> <file>
3719 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | yes
3722 Arguments :
3723 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003724 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3725 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003726
3727 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003728 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003729 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003730 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3731 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003732
3733 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3734 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3735 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3736
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003737 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003739 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3740 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3741 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3742 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3743
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003744 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3745 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003746 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003747 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3748 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3749 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003751 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3752 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3753 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003754 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3756
3757 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3758
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003759 Example :
3760 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003761 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003762 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3763 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003766errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3767 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3768 section.
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771 Arguments :
3772 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3773
3774 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3775 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3776 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3777
3778 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3779 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3780 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3781 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3782 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3783 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3784 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3785
3786 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3787 3.8 about http-errors.
3788
3789 Example :
3790 errorfiles generic
3791 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3792
3793
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003794errorloc <code> <url>
3795errorloc302 <code> <url>
3796 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 yes | yes | yes | yes
3799 Arguments :
3800 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003801 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3802 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003803
3804 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3805 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3806 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3807 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003808 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003809
3810 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3811 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3812 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3813
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003814 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3817 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3818 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3819 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003820 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003821 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3822 request.
3823
3824 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3825
3826
3827errorloc303 <code> <url>
3828 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3830 yes | yes | yes | yes
3831 Arguments :
3832 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003833 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3834 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003835
3836 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3837 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3838 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3839 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003840 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003841
3842 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3843 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3844 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3845
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003846 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3847
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003848 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3849 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3850 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3851 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003852 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853
3854 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3855
3856
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003857email-alert from <emailaddr>
3858 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003859 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3861 yes | yes | yes | yes
3862
3863 Arguments :
3864
3865 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3866
3867 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3868 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3869
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003870 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003871 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3872 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873
3874
3875email-alert level <level>
3876 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3877 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | yes | yes | yes
3880
3881 Arguments :
3882
3883 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3884 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3885 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3886
3887 By default level is alert
3888
3889 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3890 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3891 for the proxy.
3892
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003893 Alerts are sent when :
3894
3895 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3896 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3897 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3898 is notice or lower
3899 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3900 and a health check status update occurs
3901
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003902 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3903 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003904 section 3.6 about mailers.
3905
3906
3907email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3908 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3910 yes | yes | yes | yes
3911
3912 Arguments :
3913
3914 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3915
3916 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3917 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3918
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003919 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3920 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003921
3922
3923email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3924 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3925 mailers.
3926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3927 yes | yes | yes | yes
3928
3929 Arguments :
3930
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003931 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003932
3933 By default the systems hostname is used.
3934
3935 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3936 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3937 for the proxy.
3938
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003939 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3940 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003941
3942
3943email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003944 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003945 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3947 yes | yes | yes | yes
3948
3949 Arguments :
3950
3951 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3952
3953 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3954 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3955
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003956 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003957 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3958
3959
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003960force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3961 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003963 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003964
3965 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3966 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3967 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3968 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3969 marked down for maintenance operations.
3970
3971 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3972 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3973 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3974 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3975 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3976 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3977 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3978 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3979 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3980
3981 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3982 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3983 is used.
3984
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003985 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003986 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003987
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003988
3989filter <name> [param*]
3990 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 no | yes | yes | yes
3993 Arguments :
3994 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3995 referenced in section 9.
3996
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003997 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003998 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003999 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4000 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004001
4002 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4003 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4004
4005 Example:
4006 listen
4007 bind *:80
4008
4009 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4010 filter compression
4011 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4012
4013 compression algo gzip
4014 compression offload
4015
4016 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4017
4018 See also : section 9.
4019
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004020
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004021fullconn <conns>
4022 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments :
4026 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4027 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4028
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004029 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004030 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004031 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004032 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4033 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4034 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4035 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4036 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004037 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004038
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004039 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4040 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004041 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4042 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4043 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004044
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004045 Example :
4046 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4047 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4048 # connections.
4049 backend dynamic
4050 fullconn 10000
4051 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4052 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4053
4054 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4055
4056
4057grace <time>
4058 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004060 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004061 Arguments :
4062 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4063 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4064 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4065
4066 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4067 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004068 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004069 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4070
4071 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4072 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4073 simplify it.
4074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004076hash-balance-factor <factor>
4077 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | no | no | yes
4080 Arguments :
4081 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4082 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004083 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004084
4085 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4086 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4087 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4088 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4089 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4090 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4091 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4092
4093 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4094 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4095 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4096 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4097 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4098
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004099 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4100 consistent hashing mechanism.
4101
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004102 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4103
4104
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004105hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004106 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | no | yes | yes
4109 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004110 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4111 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004112
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004113 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4114 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4115 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4116 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4117 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4118 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4119 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4120 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4121 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4122 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004123
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004124 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4125 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4126 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4127 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4128 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4129 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4130 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4131 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4132 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4133 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4134 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4135 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4136 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004137 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4138 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004139
4140 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4141
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004142 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004143 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4144 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4145 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004146 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4147 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4148 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004149
4150 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4151 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004152 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4153 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4154 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4155 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4156
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004157 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4158 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4159 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4160 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4161 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4162 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4163 parameter.
4164
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004165 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4166 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4167 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4168 used on strings.
4169
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004170 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4171
4172 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4173 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4174 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4175 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4176 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4177 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4178 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4179 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4180 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4181 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4182 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4183 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004184
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004185 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4186 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4187 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004188
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004189 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004190
4191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004192http-check disable-on-404
4193 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004195 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004196 Arguments : none
4197
4198 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4199 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4200 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4201 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4202 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4203 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4204 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4205 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004206 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4207 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4208 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4209
4210 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4211
4212
4213http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004214 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004216 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004217 Arguments :
4218 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4219 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004220 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004221 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4222 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4223 details on the supported keywords.
4224
4225 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4226 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4227 with the usual backslash ('\').
4228
4229 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4230 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4231 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4232 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4233 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4234
4235 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004236 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004237 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4238 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4239 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4240
4241 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004242 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004243 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4244 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4245 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4246 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4247
4248 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004249 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004250 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4251 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4252 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4253 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4254 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004255 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004256 trace).
4257
4258 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004259 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004260 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4261 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4262 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4263 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4264 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004265 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004266
4267 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4268 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4269 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4270 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4271 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4272 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4273 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4274 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4275
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004276 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4277 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4278 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4279
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004280 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4281 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4282
4283 Examples :
4284 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004285 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004286
4287 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004288 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004289
4290 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004291 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004292
4293 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004294 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004296 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004297
4298
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004299http-check send-state
4300 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4302 yes | no | yes | yes
4303 Arguments : none
4304
4305 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4306 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4307 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4308 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4309 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4310
4311 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4312 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4313 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4314 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4315 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004316 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4317 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4318 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4319
4320 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4321 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4322 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4323
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004324 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4325 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4326 checked in multiple backends.
4327
4328 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4329 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4330
4331 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4332 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4333 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4334 one fails.
4335
4336 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4337 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4338 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4339
4340 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4341 server's queue.
4342
4343 Example of a header received by the application server :
4344 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4345 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4346
4347 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349
4350http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004351 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4352
4353 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4354 no | yes | yes | yes
4355
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004356 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4357 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4358 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4359 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4360 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4363 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 Example:
4368 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4369 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4370 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372 http-request allow if nagios
4373 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4374 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4375 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004377 Example:
4378 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4379 acl add path /addacl
4380 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4385 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387 Example:
4388 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4389 acl setmap path /setmap
4390 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4395 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4398 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4403 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4404 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4405 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4406 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4407 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4408 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4409 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4414 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4415 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4416 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4417 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4418 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4419 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4420 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4425 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004426
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004428http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4431 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4432 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4433 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4434 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436 Example:
4437 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4438 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004439
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004440http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004441
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004442 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004447 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4448 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4449 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4450 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4451 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4452 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4453 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4454 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4455 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004457 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4458 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4459 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004460 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4461
4462 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4463 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4464 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4465 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004468
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004469 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4470 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4471 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4472 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4473 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4474 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004476http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004478 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004480http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4483 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4484 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4485 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4486 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4487 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004488
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004489http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4490 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4493 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4494 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004495 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4496 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4497 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4498 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4499 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004500 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004501
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004502http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4503 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4504 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4505 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4506
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004507http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4508
4509 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4510 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4511 pointed by <resolvers>.
4512 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4513 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4514 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4515 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4516 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4517 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4518 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4519 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4520 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4521 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4522 to 0.0.0.0.
4523
4524 Example:
4525 resolvers mydns
4526 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4527 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4528 timeout retry 1s
4529 hold valid 10s
4530 hold nx 3s
4531 hold other 3s
4532 hold obsolete 0s
4533 accepted_payload_size 8192
4534
4535 frontend fe
4536 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4537 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4538 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4539
4540 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4541 # which mean DNS resolution error
4542 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4543
4544 default_backend be
4545
4546 backend b_503
4547 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4548 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4549 # 503 error page to end users
4550
4551 backend be
4552 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4553 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4554 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4555 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4556 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4557
4558 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4559 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4560
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004561http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4562
4563 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4564 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4565 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4566 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004567 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4568 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004569
4570 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004572http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4575 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4576 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4577 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4578 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4583 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4584 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4585 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004589
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004590 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4591 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4592 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4593 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4594 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4595 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004596
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004597 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4598 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4599 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4600 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4601 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004602
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004603 Example:
4604 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4605
4606 # applied to:
4607 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4608
4609 # outputs:
4610 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4611
4612 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004613
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004614 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4615
4616 # applied to:
4617 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004618
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004619 # outputs:
4620 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004621
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004622http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4624
4625 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4626 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4627 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4628 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4629
4630 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4631 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4632 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4633
4634 Example:
4635 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4636 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4637
4638 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4639 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4640
4641 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4642 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4643 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4644 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4645
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004646http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4647 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4648
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004649 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4650 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4651 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4652 against.
4653
4654 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4655 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4656 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004657
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004658 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4659 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4660 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4661 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4662 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4663 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4664 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4665 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4666 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004667 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4668 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004669
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004670 Example:
4671 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4672 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004673
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004674 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4675 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004679
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004680 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4681 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4682 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4683 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004684
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004685 Example:
4686 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004687
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004688 # applied to:
4689 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004690
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004691 # outputs:
4692 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4695http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004697 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4698 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4699 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004700
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004701http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4702 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004703
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004704 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4705 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4706 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4707 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004711 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4712 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4713 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4714 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4715 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717 Arguments:
4718 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4719 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721 Example:
4722 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4723 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004725 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4726 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004728http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004730 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4731 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4732 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004734 Arguments:
4735 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4736 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004738 Example:
4739 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4740 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4743 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4744 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4749 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4750 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4751 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4752 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004754 Example:
4755 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4756 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4757 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4758 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4759 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4760 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4761 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4762 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4763 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004765http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4768 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4769 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4770 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4771 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004773http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4774 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004776 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4777 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4778 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4779 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4780 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4781 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4782 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4783 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4784 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004786http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004788 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4789 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4790 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4791 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4792 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4793 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4794 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004798 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4799 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4800 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004802http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004804 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4805 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4806 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4807 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4808 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4809 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4810 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4811 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004813http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004815 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4816 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4817 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4818 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4819 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4820 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004822 Example :
4823 # prepend the host name before the path
4824 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004826http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004828 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4829 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4830 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4831 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4832 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004834http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004836 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4837 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4838 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4839 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4840 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4841 values have higher priority.
4842 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4843 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4844 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4845 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4846 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004848http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004850 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4851 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4852 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4853 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4854 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4855 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4856 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004858 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004859
4860 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004861 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4862 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004864http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4865 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4866 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4867 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4868 privacy.
4869
4870 Arguments :
4871 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4872 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004873
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004874 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004875 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4876 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4877
4878 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4879 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4880
4881http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4882
4883 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4884 expression.
4885
4886 Arguments:
4887 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4888 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004889
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004890 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004891 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4892 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4893
4894 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4895 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4896 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4897
4898http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4899
4900 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4901 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4902 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4903 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4904 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4905 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4906 information from the request.
4907
4908 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4909
4910http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4911
4912 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4913 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4914 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4915 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4916 path and the query string.
4917 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4918
4919http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4920
4921 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4922 inline.
4923
4924 Arguments:
4925 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4926 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4927 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4928 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4929 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4930 (request and response)
4931 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4932 processing
4933 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4934 processing
4935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4936 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4937 and '_'.
4938
4939 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4940 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004941
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004942 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004943 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004945http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4946 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004948 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4949 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4950 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4951 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4952 agent name must be used.
4953
4954 Arguments:
4955 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4956
4957 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4958 configuration.
4959
4960http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4961
4962 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4963 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4964 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4965 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4966 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4967 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4968 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4969 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4970 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4971 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4972 action.
4973 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4974 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4975 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4976 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4977 you fully understand how it works.
4978
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004979http-request strict-mode { on | off }
4980
4981 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4982 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4983 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4984 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4985 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4986 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
4987 processing.
4988
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01004989 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004990 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4991 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
4992 rules evaluation.
4993
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004994http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4995 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004996
4997 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4998 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4999 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5000 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5001 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5002 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5003 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5004 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5005 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5006 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5007 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005008 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5009 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5010 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5011 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5012 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5014
5015http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5016http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5017http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5018
5019 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5020 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5021 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5022 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5023 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5024 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5025 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5026 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5027 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5028 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5029 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5030 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5031
5032 Arguments :
5033 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5034 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5035 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5036 select which table entry to update the counters.
5037
5038 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5039 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5040 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5041 that table until the session ends.
5042
5043 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5044 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5045 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5046 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5047 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5048 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5049 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5050 useful information.
5051
5052 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5053 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5054 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5055 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5056 checks that make use of it.
5057
5058http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5059
5060 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005061
5062 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005063 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005064
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005065http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5066
5067 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5068 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5069 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5070 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5071 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5072 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5073
5074 Arguments :
5075 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5076
5077 Example:
5078 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005080http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005082 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5083 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5084 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005085
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005088 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5089
5090 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5091 no | yes | yes | yes
5092
5093 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5094 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5095 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5096 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5097 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5098 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005100 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5101 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 Example:
5106 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005108 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005110 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5111 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005113 Example:
5114 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5119 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5122 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005124http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005126 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5127 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5128 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5129 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5130 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5131 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5132 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5133 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005135http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005137 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5138 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5139 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5140 example, or to pass some internal information.
5141 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5142 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5143 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005147 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5148 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005149
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005150http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005151
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005152 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005154http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005156 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5157 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5158 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5159 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5160 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5161 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5162 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5165 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5166 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5167 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5168 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005169
5170 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5171 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5172 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5173 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005175http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005177 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5178 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5179 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5180 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5181 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5182 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005186 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005188http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005190 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5191 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5192 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5193 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5194 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5195 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005196
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005197http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5198 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005200 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005201 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5202 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005203 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5204 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5205 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5206 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5207 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005208 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005210http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005212 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5213 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5214 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5215 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5216 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5217 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005219http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5220 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005221
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005222 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5223 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005225 Example:
5226 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005228 # applied to:
5229 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005231 # outputs:
5232 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005234 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005235
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005236http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5237 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005238
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005239 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005240 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005242 Example:
5243 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005245 # applied to:
5246 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005248 # outputs:
5249 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005251http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5252http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005253
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005254 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5255 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5256 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005257
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005258http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5259 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005260
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005261 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5262 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5263 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5264 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005265
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005266http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005267
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005268 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5269 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5270 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5271 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5272 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005274 Arguments:
5275 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005277 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5278 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005280http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005282 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5283 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5284 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005286http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5287
5288 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5289 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5290 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5291 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5292 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5293
5294http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5295
5296 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5297 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5298 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5299 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5300 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5301 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5302 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5303 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5304 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5305
5306http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5307
5308 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5309 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5310 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5311 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5312 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5313 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5314 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5315
5316http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5317
5318 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5319 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5320 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5321 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5322 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5323 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5324 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5325 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5326
5327http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5328 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5329
5330 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5331 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5332 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5333 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005334
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005335 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005336 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5337 http-response set-status 431
5338 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5339 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005340
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005341http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005342
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005343 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5344 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5345 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5346 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5347 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5348 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5349 based on some information from the request.
5350
5351 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5352
5353http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5354
5355 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5356 inline.
5357
5358 Arguments:
5359 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5360 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5361 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5362 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5363 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5364 (request and response)
5365 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5366 processing
5367 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5368 processing
5369 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5370 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5371 and '_'.
5372
5373 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5374 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005375
5376 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005377 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005378
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005379http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005380
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005381 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5382 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5383 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5384 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5385 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5386 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5387 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5388 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5389 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5390 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5391 action.
5392 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5393 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5394 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5395 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5396 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005397
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005398http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5399
5400 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5401 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5402 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5403 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5404 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5405 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5406 processing.
5407
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005408 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005409 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5410 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5411 rules evaluation.
5412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005413http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5414http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5415http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005417 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5418 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5419 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5420 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5421 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5422 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5423
5424http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5425
5426 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5427 about <var-name>.
5428
5429 Example:
5430 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5431
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005432
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005433http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5434 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5435
5436 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | no | yes | yes
5438
5439 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005440 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5441 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5442 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005443
5444 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5445
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005446 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5447 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5448 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5449 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5450 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5451 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5452 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5453 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5454 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5455 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005456
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005457 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5458 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5459 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5460 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5461 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5462 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5463 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5464 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005465
5466 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5467 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5468 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5469 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5470 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5471 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5472 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5473 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005474 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005475 downsides of rare connection failures.
5476
5477 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5478 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5479 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5480 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5481 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5482 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005483 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005484 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5485 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5486 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5487 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5488 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5489
5490 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005491 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5492 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5493 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005494
5495 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005496 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005497
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005498 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5499 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005500
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005501 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005502
5503 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5504 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5505 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5506
5507 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5508
5509
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005510http-send-name-header [<header>]
5511 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005512 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5513 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005514 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005515 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5516
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005517 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5518 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5519 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5520 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5521 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5522 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5523 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5524 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5525 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5526 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5527 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5528 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5529 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5530 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5531 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5532 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005533
5534 See also : "server"
5535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005536id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005537 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 no | yes | yes | yes
5540 Arguments : none
5541
5542 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5543 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5544 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005545
5546
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005547ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5548 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005550 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005551
5552 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5553 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5554 and running).
5555
5556 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5557 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5558 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005559 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005560 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5561
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005562 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5563 "unless" condition is met.
5564
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005565 Example:
5566 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5567 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5568 ignore-persist if url_static
5569
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005570 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5571
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005572load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5573 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | no | yes | yes
5576
5577 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5578 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5579 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005580 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005581 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5582 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5583 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5584 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5585
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005586 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005587 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005588 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005589
5590 Arguments:
5591 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5592 named "server-state-file".
5593
5594 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5595 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5596 name is used as a file name.
5597
5598 none don't load any stat for this backend
5599
5600 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005601 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5602 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5603 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005604 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005605 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005606
5607 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5608 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5609
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005610 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005611
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005612 global
5613 stats socket /tmp/socket
5614 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005615
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005616 defaults
5617 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005618
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005619 backend bk
5620 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5621 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005622
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005623
5624 Then one can run :
5625
5626 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5627
5628 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5629
5630 1
5631 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5632 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5633 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5634
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005635 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005636
5637 global
5638 stats socket /tmp/socket
5639 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5640
5641 defaults
5642 load-server-state-from-file local
5643
5644 backend bk
5645 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5646 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5647
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005648
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005649 Then one can run :
5650
5651 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5652
5653 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5654
5655 1
5656 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5657 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5658 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5659
5660 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5661 "show servers state"
5662
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005663
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005664log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005665log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5666 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005667no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005668 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5670 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005671
5672 Prefix :
5673 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5674 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5675 prefix does not allow arguments.
5676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005677 Arguments :
5678 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5679 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5680 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5681 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5682 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5683 parameter.
5684
5685 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5686 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5687
5688 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5689 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5690 standard syslog port).
5691
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005692 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5693 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5694 standard syslog port).
5695
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005696 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5697 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5698 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005699 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005700
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005701 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5702 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5703 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5704 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5705 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5706 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5707 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5708 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5709 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5710 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5711 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5712 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5713 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5714 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5715 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5716 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005717 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5718 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005719
5720 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5721 and "fd@2", see above.
5722
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005723 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5724 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5725 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5726 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5727 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5728 having the logs instantly available.
5729
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005730 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5731 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005732
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005733 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5734 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5735 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5736 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5737 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5738 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5739 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5740 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5741 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5742 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005743 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005744
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005745 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5746 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5747 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5748 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5749 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5750
5751 <sample_size>
5752 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5753 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5754 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5755 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5756 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5757
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005758 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5759 one of the following :
5760
5761 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5762 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5763
5764 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5765 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5766
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005767 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5768 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5769 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5770 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5771 systemd logger consumes.
5772
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005773 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5774 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5775 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5776 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5777
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005778 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5779
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005780 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5781 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5782 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5783
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005784 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5785 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5786 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5787 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005788
5789 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5790 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5791 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005792 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5793 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5794 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5795 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5796 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005797
5798 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5799
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005800 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5801 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5802 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005803
5804 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5805 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5806 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5807 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5808
5809 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5810 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005811
5812 Example :
5813 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005814 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5815 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5816 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005817 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5818 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005819 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005820
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005821
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005822log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005823 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005826
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005827 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5828 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5829 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5830 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5831 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005832
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005833 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5834 "option httplog" directives.
5835
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005836log-format-sd <string>
5837 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5839 yes | yes | yes | no
5840
5841 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5842 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5843 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5844 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5845 which covers the log format string in depth.
5846
5847 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5848 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5849
5850 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5851 log format to "rfc5424".
5852
5853 Example :
5854 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5855
5856
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005857log-tag <string>
5858 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5859 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5860 yes | yes | yes | yes
5861
5862 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5863 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5864 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5865 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5866 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5867 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5868 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5869 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5870 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005871
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005872max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5873 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5875 yes | no | yes | yes
5876
5877 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5878 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5879 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5880 servers.
5881
5882 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5883 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5884 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5885 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5886 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005887 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005888 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5889 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5890 picking a different server.
5891
5892 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5893 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5894 even if they have to be queued.
5895
5896 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5897 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5898
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005899max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5900 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5901 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5902 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005904maxconn <conns>
5905 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5907 yes | yes | yes | no
5908 Arguments :
5909 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5910 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5911 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5912 closes.
5913
5914 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5915 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5916 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5917 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005918 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5919 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5920 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5921 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005922
5923 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5924 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5925 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5926
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005927 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5928 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005929
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005930 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5931
5932
5933mode { tcp|http|health }
5934 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | yes | yes | yes
5937 Arguments :
5938 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5939 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5940 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5941 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5942
5943 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5944 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5945 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5946 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5947 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5948
5949 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005950 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5951 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5952 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5953 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5954 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5955 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5956 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005957
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005958 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5959 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5960 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005961
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005962 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005963 defaults http_instances
5964 mode http
5965
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005966 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005968
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005969monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005970 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5972 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005973 Arguments :
5974 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5975 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005976 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005977 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5978 backend and its backup.
5979
5980 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5981 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5982 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5983 servers in a list of backends.
5984
5985 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5986 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5987 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5988 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5989 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5990 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5991 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005992 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5993 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005994
5995 Example:
5996 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005997 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005998 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5999 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6000 monitor-uri /site_alive
6001 monitor fail if site_dead
6002
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006003 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006004
6005
6006monitor-net <source>
6007 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6009 yes | yes | yes | no
6010 Arguments :
6011 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6012 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6013 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6014 followed by a mask.
6015
6016 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6017 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006018 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006019 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6020
6021 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6022 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6023 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6024 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006025 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6026 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6027 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006028
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006029 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6030 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6031 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6032 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6033 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6034 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006035
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006036 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6037 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006038
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006039 Example :
6040 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6041 frontend www
6042 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6043
6044 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6045
6046
6047monitor-uri <uri>
6048 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6050 yes | yes | yes | no
6051 Arguments :
6052 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6053 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6054
6055 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6056 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6057 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6058 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6059 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6060 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6061 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6062 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6063
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006064 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006065 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6066 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6067 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6068 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6069 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6070 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006071
6072 Example :
6073 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6074 frontend www
6075 mode http
6076 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6077
6078 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006080
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006081option abortonclose
6082no option abortonclose
6083 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6085 yes | no | yes | yes
6086 Arguments : none
6087
6088 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6089 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6090 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6091 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006092 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006093 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6094 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6095 encountered while delivering the response.
6096
6097 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6098 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6099 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6100 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6101 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6102 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006103 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006104 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006105 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006106 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6107 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6108 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6109
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006110 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6111 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006112 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6113 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6114 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6115 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6116 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6117 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006118 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006119
6120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6122
6123 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6124
6125
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006126option accept-invalid-http-request
6127no option accept-invalid-http-request
6128 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | yes | yes | no
6131 Arguments : none
6132
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006133 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006134 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006135 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006136 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6137 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6138 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6139 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6140 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006141 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6142 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6143 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6144 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006145 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006146 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006147 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6148 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6149 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006150
6151 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6152 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6153 been confirmed.
6154
6155 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6156 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006157 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6158 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006159 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6160
6161 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6162 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6163
6164 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6165 stats socket.
6166
6167
6168option accept-invalid-http-response
6169no option accept-invalid-http-response
6170 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6172 yes | no | yes | yes
6173 Arguments : none
6174
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006175 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006176 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006177 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006178 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6179 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6180 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6181 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6182 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006183 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6184 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6185 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006186
6187 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6188 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6189 been confirmed.
6190
6191 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6192 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6193 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6194 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6195
6196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6198
6199 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6200 stats socket.
6201
6202
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006203option allbackups
6204no option allbackups
6205 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6207 yes | no | yes | yes
6208 Arguments : none
6209
6210 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6211 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6212 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6213 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6214 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6215 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6216 order between the backup servers anymore.
6217
6218 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6219 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6220
6221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6223
6224
6225option checkcache
6226no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006227 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6229 yes | no | yes | yes
6230 Arguments : none
6231
6232 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6233 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006234 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006235 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6236 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006237 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006238
6239 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006240 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006241 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006242 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6243 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006244 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006245 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006246 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6247 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006248 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006249 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6250 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006251 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006252 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6253 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6254 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6255 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6256 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6257 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6258 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6259 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6260 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6261
6262 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006263 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6264 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6265 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6266 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006267
6268 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6269 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006270 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006271 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006272
6273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6275
6276
6277option clitcpka
6278no option clitcpka
6279 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6281 yes | yes | yes | no
6282 Arguments : none
6283
6284 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6285 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006286 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006287 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6288
6289 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6290 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6291 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6292 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6293
6294 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6295 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6296 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6297 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6298 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6299
6300 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6301
6302 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6303 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6304 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6305
6306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6308
6309 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6310
6311
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006312option contstats
6313 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6315 yes | yes | yes | no
6316 Arguments : none
6317
6318 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6319 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6320 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6321 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006322 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6323 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6324 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6325 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6326 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006327
6328
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006329option dontlog-normal
6330no option dontlog-normal
6331 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 yes | yes | yes | no
6334 Arguments : none
6335
6336 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6337 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6338 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6339 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6340 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6341 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6342 logged.
6343
6344 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6345 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6346 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006348 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006349 logging.
6350
6351
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006352option dontlognull
6353no option dontlognull
6354 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6356 yes | yes | yes | no
6357 Arguments : none
6358
6359 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6360 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6361 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6362 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6363 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6364 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006365 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6366 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6367 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006368
6369 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006370 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006371 would not be logged.
6372
6373 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6374 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6375
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006376 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6377 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006378
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006379
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006380option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006381 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6383 yes | yes | yes | yes
6384 Arguments :
6385 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6386 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006387 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006388 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006389
6390 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6391 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6392 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6393 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6394 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6395 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6396 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006397 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6398 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6399 possible that the client has already brought one.
6400
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006401 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006402 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006403 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006404 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006405 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006406 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006407
6408 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6409 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6410 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6411 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6412 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6413 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6414 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6415
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006416 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6417 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6418 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6419 are under the control of the end-user.
6420
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006421 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006422 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6423 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006424 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6425 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6426 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006427
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006428 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006429 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6430 frontend www
6431 mode http
6432 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6433
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006434 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6435 backend www
6436 mode http
6437 option forwardfor header X-Client
6438
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006439 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006440 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006441
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006442
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006443option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6444no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6445 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 yes | yes | yes | no
6448 Arguments : none
6449
6450 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6451 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6452 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6453 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6454 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6455 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6456 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6457
6458 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6459 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6460 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6461 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6462 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6463 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6464 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6465 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6466 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6467 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6468
6469 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6470
6471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6473
6474 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6475 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6476
6477
6478option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6479no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6480 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6482 yes | no | yes | yes
6483 Arguments : none
6484
6485 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6486 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6487 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6488 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6489 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6490 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6491 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6492
6493 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6494 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6495 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6496 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6497 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6498 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6499 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6500 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6501 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6502 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6503
6504 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6505
6506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6508
6509 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6510 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6511
6512
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006513option http-buffer-request
6514no option http-buffer-request
6515 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6517 yes | yes | yes | yes
6518 Arguments : none
6519
6520 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6521 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6522 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6523 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6524 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6525 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006526 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6527 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6528 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6529 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006530
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006531 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006532
6533
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006534option http-ignore-probes
6535no option http-ignore-probes
6536 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6538 yes | yes | yes | no
6539 Arguments : none
6540
6541 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6542 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6543 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6544 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6545 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6546 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6547 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6548 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6549 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006550 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6551 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006552 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6553
6554 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6555 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6556 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6557 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6558 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6559 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6560 are often the only way to detect them.
6561
6562 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6563 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6564
6565 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6566
6567
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006568option http-keep-alive
6569no option http-keep-alive
6570 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6572 yes | yes | yes | yes
6573 Arguments : none
6574
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006575 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6576 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006577 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6578 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006579 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6580 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6581 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006582
6583 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6584 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006585 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6586 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6587 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6588 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6589 situations where this option may be useful :
6590
6591 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006592 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006593
6594 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6595 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6596
6597 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6598 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6599 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6600 request.
6601
6602 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6603 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006604 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6605 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6606 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006607
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006608 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6609 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6610 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6611 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6612 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6613 not set.
6614
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006615 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6616 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6617 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006618
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006619 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006620 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006621 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006622
6623
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006624option http-no-delay
6625no option http-no-delay
6626 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6628 yes | yes | yes | yes
6629 Arguments : none
6630
6631 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6632 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6633 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6634 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6635 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6636 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6637 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6638 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6639 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6640 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6641 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6642 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6643 affected.
6644
6645 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6646 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6647 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6648 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6649 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6650 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6651 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6652 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6653 latency environments.
6654
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006655 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6656
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006657
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006658option http-pretend-keepalive
6659no option http-pretend-keepalive
6660 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006662 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006663 Arguments : none
6664
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006665 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006666 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6667 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6668 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6669 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6670 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6671 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6672 consider the response complete.
6673
6674 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6675 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6676 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6677 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006678 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006679 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6680
6681 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6682 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6683 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6684 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6685 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6686 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6687 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6688
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006689 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6690 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6691 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6692 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6693 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6694 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006695
6696 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6697 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6698
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006699 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006700 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006701
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006702
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006703option http-server-close
6704no option http-server-close
6705 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 yes | yes | yes | yes
6708 Arguments : none
6709
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006710 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6711 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6712 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6713 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006714 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6715 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6716 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6717 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6718 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6719 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6720 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6721 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6722 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6723 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6724 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006725
6726 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6727 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6728 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6729 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006730 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6731 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006732
6733 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6734 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006735 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6736 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6737 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006738
6739 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6740 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6741
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006742 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6743 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006744
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006745option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006746no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006747 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6749 yes | yes | yes | no
6750 Arguments : none
6751
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006752 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006753 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6754 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6755 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6756 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6757 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6758 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6759
6760 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6761 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006762 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6763 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6764 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006765
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006766 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6767 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6768 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6769 front of an existing proxy.
6770
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006771 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6772
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006773 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006774
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006775option httpchk
6776option httpchk <uri>
6777option httpchk <method> <uri>
6778option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6779 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6781 yes | no | yes | yes
6782 Arguments :
6783 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6784 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6785 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6786 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6787 ones.
6788
6789 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6790 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6791 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6792
6793 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6794 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6795 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6796 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6797 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6798
6799 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6800 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6801 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6802 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6803 the lack of any response.
6804
6805 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6806
6807 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6808 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6809 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6810
6811 Examples :
6812 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6813 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6814 backend https_relay
6815 mode tcp
6816 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6817 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6818
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006819 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6820 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6821 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006822
6823
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006824option httpclose
6825no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006826 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6828 yes | yes | yes | yes
6829 Arguments : none
6830
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006831 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6832 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6833 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6834 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006835 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006836
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006837 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6838 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006839 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006840 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6841 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006842
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006843 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6844 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6845 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006846
6847 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6848 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006849 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6850 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6851 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006852
6853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6855
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006856 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006857
6858
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006859option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006860 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006862 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006863 Arguments :
6864 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6865 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6866 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006867 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006868 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006869
6870 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6871 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6872 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6873 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6874 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6875 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6876 ports.
6877
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006878 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6879 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006880
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006881 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006883 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006884
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006885
6886option http_proxy
6887no option http_proxy
6888 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6890 yes | yes | yes | yes
6891 Arguments : none
6892
6893 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6894 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6895 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6896 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6897 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6898
6899 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6900 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006901 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6902 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006903
6904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6906
6907 Example :
6908 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6909 backend direct_forward
6910 option httpclose
6911 option http_proxy
6912
6913 See also : "option httpclose"
6914
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006915
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006916option independent-streams
6917no option independent-streams
6918 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | yes | yes | yes
6921 Arguments : none
6922
6923 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6924 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6925 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6926 receive data or not.
6927
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006928 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006929 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6930 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6931 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6932 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6933 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6934 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6935 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6936 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6937 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6938 socket buffers.
6939
6940 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6941 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6942 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6943 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6944 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6945
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006946 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006947
6948
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006949option ldap-check
6950 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 yes | no | yes | yes
6953 Arguments : none
6954
6955 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6956 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6957 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6958 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6959
6960 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6961 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6962
6963 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6964 configure it.
6965
6966 Example :
6967 option ldap-check
6968
6969 See also : "option httpchk"
6970
6971
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006972option external-check
6973 Use external processes for server health checks
6974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6975 yes | no | yes | yes
6976
6977 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6978 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6979 command".
6980
6981 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6982
6983 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6984
6985
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006986option log-health-checks
6987no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006988 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | no | yes | yes
6991 Arguments : none
6992
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006993 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6994 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6995 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006996
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006997 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6998 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6999 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7000 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7001 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007003 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007004 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007005
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007006 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7007 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7008 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007009
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007010
7011option log-separate-errors
7012no option log-separate-errors
7013 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 yes | yes | yes | no
7016 Arguments : none
7017
7018 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7019 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7020 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7021 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7022 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7023 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7024 provides very important information.
7025
7026 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7027 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7028 error logs.
7029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007030 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007031 logging.
7032
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007033
7034option logasap
7035no option logasap
7036 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7038 yes | yes | yes | no
7039 Arguments : none
7040
7041 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7042 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7043 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7044 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7045 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7046 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7047 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007048 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007049 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7050 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7051
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007052 Examples :
7053 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7054 mode http
7055 option httplog
7056 option logasap
7057 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7058
7059 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7060 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7061 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7062 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007064 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007065 logging.
7066
7067
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007068option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007069 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7071 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007072 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007073 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7074 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007075 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007076
7077 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7078 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007079 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007080 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7081 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7082 in the MySQL table, like this :
7083
7084 USE mysql;
7085 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7086 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7087
7088 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007089 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007090 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7091 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7092 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7093 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7094 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7095 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7096 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7097
7098 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7099 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007100
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007101 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007102
7103 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7104 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7105 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7106 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007107 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7108 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007109
7110 See also: "option httpchk"
7111
7112
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007113option nolinger
7114no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007115 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007116 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7117 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007118 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007120 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007121 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7122 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7123 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7124 connections.
7125
7126 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7127 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7128 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7129 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7130 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7131 this too.
7132
7133 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7134 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7135 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7136
7137 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7138 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7139 for servers.
7140
7141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7143
7144
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007145option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7146 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 yes | yes | yes | yes
7149 Arguments :
7150 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7151 matching <network>
7152 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7153 header name.
7154
7155 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7156 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7157 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7158 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7159 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7160 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7161 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7162 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7163 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7164 possible that the client has already brought one.
7165
7166 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7167 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7168 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7169 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7170 header and requires different one.
7171
7172 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7173 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7174 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7175 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7176 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7177 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7178 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7179
7180 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7181 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7182 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7183 both are defined.
7184
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007185 Examples :
7186 # Original Destination address
7187 frontend www
7188 mode http
7189 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7190
7191 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7192 backend www
7193 mode http
7194 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007196 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007197
7198
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007199option persist
7200no option persist
7201 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7203 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007204 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007205
7206 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7207 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7208 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7209 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7210 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7211 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7212 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7213 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7214 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7215 redirected to another valid server.
7216
7217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7219
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007220 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007221
7222
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007223option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7224 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7226 yes | no | yes | yes
7227 Arguments :
7228 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7229 PostgreSQL server.
7230
7231 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7232 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7233 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7234 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7235
7236 See also: "option httpchk"
7237
7238
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007239option prefer-last-server
7240no option prefer-last-server
7241 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7243 yes | no | yes | yes
7244 Arguments : none
7245
7246 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7247 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7248 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7249 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7250 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7251 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7252 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7253 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7254 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007255 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7256 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007257 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7258 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7259 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007260 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7261 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7262 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007263
7264 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7265 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7266
7267 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7268
7269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007270option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007271option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007272no option redispatch
7273 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7274 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7275 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007276 Arguments :
7277 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7278 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7279 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007280 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007281 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007282 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007283 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7284 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7285 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007287
7288 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7289 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7290 be able to access the service anymore.
7291
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007292 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7293 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007294
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007295 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007296 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7297 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7301
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007302 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007303
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007304
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007305option redis-check
7306 Use redis health checks for server testing
7307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7308 yes | no | yes | yes
7309 Arguments : none
7310
7311 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7312 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7313 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7314 find the "+PONG" response message.
7315
7316 Example :
7317 option redis-check
7318
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007319 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007320
7321
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007322option smtpchk
7323option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7324 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007327 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007328 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007329 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007330 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7331
7332 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7333 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7334 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7335
7336 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7337 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7338 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7339 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7340 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7341 dead server.
7342
7343 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7344 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007345 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007346 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7347
7348 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7349 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7350 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7351 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007352 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007353
7354 Example :
7355 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7356
7357 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007360option socket-stats
7361no option socket-stats
7362
7363 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7365 yes | yes | yes | no
7366
7367 Arguments : none
7368
7369
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007370option splice-auto
7371no option splice-auto
7372 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | yes | yes | yes
7375 Arguments : none
7376
7377 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7378 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007379 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007380 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007381 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007382 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7383 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7384 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7385 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7386
7387 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7388 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7389 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7390 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7391 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7392 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7393 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7394 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7395 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7396 keyword.
7397
7398 Example :
7399 option splice-auto
7400
7401 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7402 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7403
7404 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7405 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7406
7407
7408option splice-request
7409no option splice-request
7410 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7412 yes | yes | yes | yes
7413 Arguments : none
7414
7415 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007416 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007417 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7418 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7419 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7420 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7421
7422 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7423
7424 Example :
7425 option splice-request
7426
7427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7429
7430 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7431 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7432
7433
7434option splice-response
7435no option splice-response
7436 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7438 yes | yes | yes | yes
7439 Arguments : none
7440
7441 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007442 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007443 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7444 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7445 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7446 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7447
7448 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7449
7450 Example :
7451 option splice-response
7452
7453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7455
7456 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7457 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7458
7459
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007460option spop-check
7461 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7463 no | no | no | yes
7464 Arguments : none
7465
7466 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7467 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7468 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7469 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7470
7471 Example :
7472 option spop-check
7473
7474 See also : "option httpchk"
7475
7476
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007477option srvtcpka
7478no option srvtcpka
7479 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7481 yes | no | yes | yes
7482 Arguments : none
7483
7484 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7485 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007486 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007487 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7488
7489 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7490 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7491 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7492 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7493
7494 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7495 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7496 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7497 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7498 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7499
7500 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7501
7502 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7503 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7504 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7505
7506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7508
7509 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7510
7511
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007512option ssl-hello-chk
7513 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 yes | no | yes | yes
7516 Arguments : none
7517
7518 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7519 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7520 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7521 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7522 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7523 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7524 hello message.
7525
7526 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7527 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7528 messages, which is appreciable.
7529
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007530 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7531 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7532 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007533
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007534 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7535
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007536
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007537option tcp-check
7538 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7540 yes | no | yes | yes
7541
7542 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7543 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7544
7545 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7546 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7547 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7548
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007549 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007550 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7551 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7552 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7553 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7554 only.
7555
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007556 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007557 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7558 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7559 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7560 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7561
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007562 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007563 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7564 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007565 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007566 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7567 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7568 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7569 the respective protocols.
7570 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007571 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007572
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007573 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7574 script.
7575
7576 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7577 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7578 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7579 The "comment" is of course optional.
7580
7581
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007582 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007583 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007584 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007585 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007586
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007587 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007588 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007589 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007590
7591 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7592 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007593 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007594 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007595 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007596 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007597 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007598 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007599 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7600 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007601 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007602 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7603 tcp-check expect string +OK
7604
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007605 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007606 (send many headers before analyzing)
7607 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007608 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007609 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7610 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7611 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7612 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007613 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007614
7615
7616 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7617
7618
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007619option tcp-smart-accept
7620no option tcp-smart-accept
7621 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 yes | yes | yes | no
7624 Arguments : none
7625
7626 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7627 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7628 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7629 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7630 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7631 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7632
7633 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7634 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7635 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7636 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7637
7638 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7639 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7640 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007641 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007642
7643 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7644 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7645 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7646
7647 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7648 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7649 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7650
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007651 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7652
7653
7654option tcp-smart-connect
7655no option tcp-smart-connect
7656 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7658 yes | no | yes | yes
7659 Arguments : none
7660
7661 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7662 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7663 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7664 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7665 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7666
7667 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7668 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7669 complex.
7670
7671 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7672 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7673 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7674
7675 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7676 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7677
7678 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7679
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007680
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007681option tcpka
7682 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7684 yes | yes | yes | yes
7685 Arguments : none
7686
7687 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7688 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007689 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007690 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7691
7692 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7693 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7694 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7695 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7696
7697 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7698 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7699 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7700 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7701 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7702
7703 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7704
7705 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7706 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7707 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7708 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7709 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7710 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7711 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7712 backends.
7713
7714 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7715
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007716
7717option tcplog
7718 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007720 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007721 Arguments : none
7722
7723 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7724 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7725 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7726 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7727 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7728 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7729 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7730 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7731
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007732 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007734 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007735
7736
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007737option transparent
7738no option transparent
7739 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007741 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007742 Arguments : none
7743
7744 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7745 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7746 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7747 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7748 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7749 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7750 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7751 appropriate server.
7752
7753 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7754 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7755
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007756 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007757 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007758
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007759
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007760external-check command <command>
7761 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7763 yes | no | yes | yes
7764
7765 Arguments :
7766 <command> is the external command to run
7767
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007768 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7769
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007770 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007771
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007772 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7773 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7774 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7775 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7776 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7777 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007778
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007779 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7780
7781 Environment variables :
7782 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7783 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7784
7785 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7786
7787 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7788
7789 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7790 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7791 for a UNIX socket).
7792
7793 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7794
7795 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7796
7797 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7798
7799 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7800
7801 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7802
7803 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7804 socket).
7805
7806 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7807 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7808
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007809 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7810
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007811 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7812 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7813 failed.
7814
7815 Example :
7816 external-check command /bin/true
7817
7818 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7819
7820
7821external-check path <path>
7822 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 yes | no | yes | yes
7825
7826 Arguments :
7827 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7828
7829 The default path is "".
7830
7831 Example :
7832 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7833
7834 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7835 "external-check command"
7836
7837
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007838persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007839persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007840 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7842 yes | no | yes | yes
7843 Arguments :
7844 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007845 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7846 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007847
7848 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7849 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007850 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007851 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7852 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7853 forwarded to this server.
7854
7855 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7856 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7857 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007858 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007859 a single "listen" section.
7860
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007861 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7862 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7863 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7864
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007865 Example :
7866 listen tse-farm
7867 bind :3389
7868 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7869 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7870 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7871 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7872 persist rdp-cookie
7873 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007874 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007875 balance rdp-cookie
7876 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7877 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7878
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007879 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7880 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007881
7882
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007883rate-limit sessions <rate>
7884 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7886 yes | yes | yes | no
7887 Arguments :
7888 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7889 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7890
7891 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7892 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7893 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7894 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7895 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7896 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7897
7898 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7899 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7900 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7901 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7902
7903 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7904 listen smtp
7905 mode tcp
7906 bind :25
7907 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007908 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007909
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007910 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7911 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7912 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007913
7914 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7915
7916
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007917redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7918redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7919redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007920 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7922 no | yes | yes | yes
7923
7924 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007925 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007926
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007927 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007928 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007929 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7930 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7931 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007932
7933 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7934 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7935 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7936 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7937 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007938 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7939 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7940 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7941 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007942
7943 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7944 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7945 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7946 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7947 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7948 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007949 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007950 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007951 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7952 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7953 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007954
7955 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007956 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7957 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7958 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007959 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007960 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7961 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7962 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7963 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007964
7965 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007966 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007967
7968 - "drop-query"
7969 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7970 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7971 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7972 with a location-type redirect.
7973
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007974 - "append-slash"
7975 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7976 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7977 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7978 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7979
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007980 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7981 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7982 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7983 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7984 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7985 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7986 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7987
7988 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7989 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7990 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7991 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7992 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7993 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7994 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007995
7996 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7997 acl clear dst_port 80
7998 acl secure dst_port 8080
7999 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008000 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008001 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008002 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8003
8004 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008005 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8006 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8007 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008008 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008009
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008010 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8011 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8012 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8013
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008014 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008015 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008016
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008017 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008018 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8019 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8020 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008022 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008023
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008024
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008025retries <value>
8026 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 yes | no | yes | yes
8029 Arguments :
8030 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8031 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8032 default value is 3.
8033
8034 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8035 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8036 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8037
8038 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008039 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8040 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008041
8042 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8043 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8044
8045 See also : "option redispatch"
8046
8047
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008048retry-on [list of keywords]
8049 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8051 yes | no | yes | yes
8052 Arguments :
8053 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8054 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8055 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8056 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8057
8058 none never retry
8059
8060 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8061 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8062
8063 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8064 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8065 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8066 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8067 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8068 processing the request.
8069
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008070 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8071 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8072 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8073 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8074 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8075 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8076 overflow attack for example).
8077
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008078 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8079 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8080 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8081 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8082 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8083 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8084 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8085 amplify denial of service attacks.
8086
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008087 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8088 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8089 considered to be safe to retry.
8090
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008091 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8092 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8093 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8094 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8095
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008096 all-retryable-errors
8097 retry request for any error that are considered
8098 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8099 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8100 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8101
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008102 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8103 not cumulative.
8104
8105 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8106 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8107 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8108 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8109
8110 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8111 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8112 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8113 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8114 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8115 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8116 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8117 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8118 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8119 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8120 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8121 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8122
8123 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8124 should not use this directive.
8125
8126 The default is "conn-failure".
8127
8128 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8129
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008130server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008131 Declare a server in a backend
8132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 no | no | yes | yes
8134 Arguments :
8135 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008136 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008137 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008138
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008139 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8140 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8141 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8142 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008143 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8144 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8145 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8146 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8147 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008148 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8149 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8150 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8151 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8152 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8153 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8154 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008155 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008156 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8157 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8158 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8159 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8160 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8161 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008162 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8163 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008164 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8165 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008166
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008167 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008168 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8169 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8170 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8171 adding this value to the client's port.
8172
8173 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8174 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008175 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008176
8177 Examples :
8178 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8179 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008180 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008181 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8182 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8183 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008184
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008185 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8186 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8187 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8188 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8189 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8190
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008191 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8192 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008193
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008194server-state-file-name [<file>]
8195 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8196 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8197 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8198 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8199 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8200 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8201
8202 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8203 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8204
8205 global
8206 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8207
8208 backend bk
8209 load-server-state-from-file
8210
8211 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8212 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008213
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008214server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8215 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8216 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 no | no | yes | yes
8219
8220 Arguments:
8221 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8222
8223 <num | range>
8224 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8225 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8226 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8227 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8228
8229 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8230
8231 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8232
8233 <params*>
8234 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8235 keyword.
8236
8237 Examples:
8238 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8239 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8240 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8241
8242 # or
8243 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8244
8245 # would be equivalent to:
8246 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8247 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8248 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8249
8250
8251
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008252source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008253source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008254source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008255 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8257 yes | no | yes | yes
8258 Arguments :
8259 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8260 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008261
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008262 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008263 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8264 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8265 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8266 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8267 supported prefixes are :
8268 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8269 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8270 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008271 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008272 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8273 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008274
8275 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8276 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008277 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8278 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8279 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008280
8281 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8282 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8283 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8284 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8285 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8286 <addr>.
8287
8288 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8289 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8290 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8291 port.
8292
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008293 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8294 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8295 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8296 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008297 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008298 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8299 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8300 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8301 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8302 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8303 HTTP header.
8304
8305 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8306 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008307 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008308 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8309 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8310 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8311 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8312 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8313 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8314 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8315
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008316 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8317 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8318 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8319 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8320 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8321 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8322
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008323 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8324 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8325 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8326 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8327
8328 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8329 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8330 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8331 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8332 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8333 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8334
8335 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8336 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8337 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8338 there are two methods :
8339
8340 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8341 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8342 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8343 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8344 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8345 of the client ranges may be used.
8346
8347 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8348 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8349 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8350 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8351 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8352 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8353 same session.
8354
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008355 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8356 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8357 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008358 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008359
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008360 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8361
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008362 Examples :
8363 backend private
8364 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8365 source 192.168.1.200
8366
8367 backend transparent_ssl1
8368 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8369 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8370
8371 backend transparent_ssl2
8372 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8373 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8374 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8375
8376 backend transparent_ssl3
8377 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8378 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8379 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8380
8381 backend transparent_smtp
8382 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8383 # with Tproxy version 4.
8384 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8385
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008386 backend transparent_http
8387 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8388 # proxy.
8389 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008391 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008392 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8393
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008394
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008395stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8396 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008398 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008399
8400 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8401 matched.
8402
8403 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8404 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8405
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008406 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8407 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008408 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008409
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008410 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8411 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8412 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8413 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008414
8415 Example :
8416 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8417 backend stats_localhost
8418 stats enable
8419 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8420
8421 Example :
8422 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8423 backend stats_auth
8424 stats enable
8425 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8426 stats admin if TRUE
8427
8428 Example :
8429 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8430 userlist stats-auth
8431 group admin users admin
8432 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8433 group readonly users haproxy
8434 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8435
8436 backend stats_auth
8437 stats enable
8438 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8439 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8440 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8441 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8442
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008443 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8444 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8445 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008446
8447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008448stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8449 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008451 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008452 Arguments :
8453 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8454
8455 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8456
8457 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8458 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8459 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8460 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8461 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8462 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8463
8464 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8465 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8466 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008467 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008468
8469 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8470 report using "stats scope".
8471
8472 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8473 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8474 unobvious parameters.
8475
8476 Example :
8477 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8478 backend public_www
8479 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8480 stats enable
8481 stats hide-version
8482 stats scope .
8483 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008484 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008485 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8486 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8487
8488 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8489 backend private_monitoring
8490 stats enable
8491 stats uri /admin?stats
8492 stats refresh 5s
8493
8494 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8495
8496
8497stats enable
8498 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008500 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008501 Arguments : none
8502
8503 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8504 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8505 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8506 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8507 - stats auth : no authentication
8508 - stats scope : no restriction
8509
8510 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8511 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8512 unobvious parameters.
8513
8514 Example :
8515 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8516 backend public_www
8517 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8518 stats enable
8519 stats hide-version
8520 stats scope .
8521 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008523 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8524 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8525
8526 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8527 backend private_monitoring
8528 stats enable
8529 stats uri /admin?stats
8530 stats refresh 5s
8531
8532 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8533
8534
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008535stats hide-version
8536 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008538 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008539 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008541 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8542 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8543 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8544 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8545 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8546 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008548 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8549 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8550 unobvious parameters.
8551
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008552 Example :
8553 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8554 backend public_www
8555 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008556 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008557 stats hide-version
8558 stats scope .
8559 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008560 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008561 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8562 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008563
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008564 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8565 backend private_monitoring
8566 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008567 stats uri /admin?stats
8568 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008569
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008570 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008571
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008572
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008573stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8574 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8575 Access control for statistics
8576
8577 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8578 no | no | yes | yes
8579
8580 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8581 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8582 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8583 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8584 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8585 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8586
8587 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8588 instance.
8589
8590 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8591 about ACL usage.
8592
8593
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008594stats realm <realm>
8595 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008597 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008598 Arguments :
8599 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8600 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8601 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8602
8603 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8604 using a backslash ('\').
8605
8606 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8607 only related to authentication.
8608
8609 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8610 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8611 unobvious parameters.
8612
8613 Example :
8614 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8615 backend public_www
8616 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8617 stats enable
8618 stats hide-version
8619 stats scope .
8620 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008621 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008622 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8623 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8624
8625 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8626 backend private_monitoring
8627 stats enable
8628 stats uri /admin?stats
8629 stats refresh 5s
8630
8631 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8632
8633
8634stats refresh <delay>
8635 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008637 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008638 Arguments :
8639 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8640 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8641 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8642 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8643 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8644 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8645
8646 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8647 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8648 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8649 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8650
8651 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8652 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8653 unobvious parameters.
8654
8655 Example :
8656 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8657 backend public_www
8658 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8659 stats enable
8660 stats hide-version
8661 stats scope .
8662 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008663 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008664 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8665 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8666
8667 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8668 backend private_monitoring
8669 stats enable
8670 stats uri /admin?stats
8671 stats refresh 5s
8672
8673 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8674
8675
8676stats scope { <name> | "." }
8677 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008679 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008680 Arguments :
8681 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8682 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8683 section in which the statement appears.
8684
8685 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8686 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8687 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8688 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8689 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8690 exists.
8691
8692 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8693 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8694 unobvious parameters.
8695
8696 Example :
8697 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8698 backend public_www
8699 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8700 stats enable
8701 stats hide-version
8702 stats scope .
8703 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008704 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008705 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8706 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8707
8708 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8709 backend private_monitoring
8710 stats enable
8711 stats uri /admin?stats
8712 stats refresh 5s
8713
8714 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8715
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008716
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008717stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008718 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008721
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008722 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008723 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8724
8725 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8726 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8727
8728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008730 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008731
8732 Example :
8733 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8734 backend private_monitoring
8735 stats enable
8736 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8737 stats uri /admin?stats
8738 stats refresh 5s
8739
8740 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8741 global section.
8742
8743
8744stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008745 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8747 yes | yes | yes | yes
8748 Arguments : none
8749
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008750 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008751 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8752 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8753 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8754 - IP (socket, server)
8755 - cookie (backend, server)
8756
8757 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8758 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008759 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008760
8761 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8762
8763
8764stats show-node [ <name> ]
8765 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008767 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008768 Arguments:
8769 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8770 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8771
8772 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8773 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008774 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008775
8776 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8777 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8778 unobvious parameters.
8779
8780 Example:
8781 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8782 backend private_monitoring
8783 stats enable
8784 stats show-node Europe-1
8785 stats uri /admin?stats
8786 stats refresh 5s
8787
8788 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8789 section.
8790
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008791
8792stats uri <prefix>
8793 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008795 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008796 Arguments :
8797 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8798 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8799 query string.
8800
8801 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8802 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8803 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8804 possible to reach it in the application.
8805
8806 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008807 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008808 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8809 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8810 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8811 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8812
8813 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8814 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8815 an address or a port to statistics only.
8816
8817 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8818 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8819 unobvious parameters.
8820
8821 Example :
8822 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8823 backend public_www
8824 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8825 stats enable
8826 stats hide-version
8827 stats scope .
8828 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008829 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008830 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8831 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8832
8833 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8834 backend private_monitoring
8835 stats enable
8836 stats uri /admin?stats
8837 stats refresh 5s
8838
8839 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8840
8841
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8843 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008845 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008846
8847 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008848 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008849 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008850 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008851 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8852
8853 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8854 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8855 the "stick-table" statement.
8856
8857 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8858 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8859 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8860 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8861 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8862
8863 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8864 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8865 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8866 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8867 transformation rules.
8868
8869 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8870 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8871 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8872 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8873 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8874 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8875 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8876
8877 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8878 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8879 ACL based conditions.
8880
8881 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8882 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8883 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8884 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8885
8886 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8887 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8888 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8889 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8890
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008891 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8892 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008893 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008894
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008895 Example :
8896 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8897 # last 30 minutes
8898 backend pop
8899 mode tcp
8900 balance roundrobin
8901 stick store-request src
8902 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8903 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8904 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8905
8906 backend smtp
8907 mode tcp
8908 balance roundrobin
8909 stick match src table pop
8910 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8911 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8912
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008913 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008914 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008915
8916
8917stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8918 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8920 no | no | yes | yes
8921
8922 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8923 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8924 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8925 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8926
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008927 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8928 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008929 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008930
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008931 Examples :
8932 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008933 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008934
8935 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8936 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8937 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8938
8939
8940 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8941 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8942 backend http
8943 mode http
8944 balance roundrobin
8945 stick on src table https
8946 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8947 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8948 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8949
8950 backend https
8951 mode tcp
8952 balance roundrobin
8953 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8954 stick on src
8955 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8956 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8957
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008958 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008959
8960
8961stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8962 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 no | no | yes | yes
8965
8966 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008967 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008968 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008969 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008970 server is selected.
8971
8972 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8973 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8974 the "stick-table" statement.
8975
8976 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8977 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8978 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8979 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8980 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8981 address.
8982
8983 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8984 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8985 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8986 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8987 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8988 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8989 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8990 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8991 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8992 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8993
8994 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8995 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8996 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8997 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8998 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8999 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9000 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9001
9002 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9003 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9004 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9005 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9006
9007 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9008 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9009 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9010 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9011 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9012 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009013 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9014 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9015 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9016 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9017 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9018 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009019
9020 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9021 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9022 the request.
9023
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009024 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9025 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009026 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009027
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009028 Example :
9029 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9030 # last 30 minutes
9031 backend pop
9032 mode tcp
9033 balance roundrobin
9034 stick store-request src
9035 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9036 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9037 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9038
9039 backend smtp
9040 mode tcp
9041 balance roundrobin
9042 stick match src table pop
9043 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9044 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9045
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009046 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009047 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009048
9049
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009050stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009051 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9052 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009053 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009055 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009056
9057 Arguments :
9058 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9059 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9060 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9061 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9062
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009063 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9064 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9065 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9066 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9067
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009068 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9069 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9070 instance.
9071
9072 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9073 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9074 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9075 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9076 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9077 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009078 to 32 characters.
9079
9080 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9081 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9082 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009083 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009084 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9085 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009086
9087 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009088 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9089 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009090 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9091 increase.
9092
9093 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009094 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9095 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9096 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009097
9098 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9099 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9100 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9101 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009102 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009103 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9104 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9105 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9106 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9107 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9108 parameter (see below).
9109
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009110 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9111 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9112 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9113 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9114 soft restart.
9115
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009116 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9117 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009118
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009119 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9120 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9121 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9122 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009123 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009124 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009125 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9126 if not expiration delay is specified.
9127
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009128 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9129 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9130 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9131 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009132 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9133 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9134 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9135 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9136 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9137 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9138 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9139 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9140 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9141 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9142 types and their arguments.
9143
9144 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9145 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9146 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9147 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9148
9149 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9150 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9151 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009152 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009153
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009154 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9155 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9156 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009157 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009158 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009159 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009160
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009161 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9162 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9163 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9164 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9165
9166 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9167 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9168 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9169 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9170 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9171 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9172
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009173 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9174 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9175 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9176 they were received.
9177
9178 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9179 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9180 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9181 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9182 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9183
9184 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9185 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9186 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9187 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9188 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9189
9190 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9191 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9192 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9193
9194 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9195 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9196 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9197 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9198 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9199
9200 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9201 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9202 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9203 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9204 the client side.
9205
9206 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9207 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9208 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9209 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9210 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9211 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9212 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9213
9214 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9215 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9216 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9217 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9218 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9219 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009220 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009221
9222 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9223 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9224 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9225 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9226 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9227 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9228
9229 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009230 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009231 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9232 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9233
9234 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9235 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9236 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9237 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9238 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9239 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9240 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9241 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9242 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9243 recommended for better fairness.
9244
9245 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009246 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009247 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9248 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9249
9250 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9251 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9252 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9253 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9254 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9255 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9256 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9257 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9258 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9259 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009260
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009261 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9262 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009263 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9264 reference it.
9265
9266 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9267 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009268 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9269 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9270 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009271
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009272 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9273 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9274 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9275 something that can be ignored.
9276
9277 Example:
9278 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9279 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9280 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9281 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9282
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009283 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009284 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009285
9286
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009287stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009288 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9290 no | no | yes | yes
9291
9292 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009293 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009294 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009295 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009296 server is selected.
9297
9298 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9299 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9300 the "stick-table" statement.
9301
9302 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9303 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9304 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9305 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9306
9307 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9308 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9309 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9310 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9311 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9312 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009313 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009314 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9315 rules.
9316
9317 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9318 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9319 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9320 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9321 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9322 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9323 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9324
9325 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9326 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9327 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9328 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9329
9330 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9331 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9332 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9333 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9334 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9335 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009336 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9337 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9338 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9339 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9340 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9341 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9342 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9343 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9344 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009345
9346 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9347
9348 Example :
9349 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9350 backend https
9351 mode tcp
9352 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009353 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009354 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009355
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009356 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9357 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9358
9359 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9360 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9361 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9362
9363 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9364 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009365
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009366 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9367 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9368 # at offset 44.
9369
9370 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9371 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9372
9373 # Learn on response if server hello.
9374 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009375
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009376 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9377 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9378
9379 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9380 extraction.
9381
9382
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009383tcp-check connect [params*]
9384 Opens a new connection
9385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 no | no | yes | yes
9387
9388 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9389 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9390 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9391
9392 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9393 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9394 of the sequence.
9395
9396 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9397 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9398 do.
9399
9400 Parameters :
9401 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9402 use the TCP connection.
9403
9404 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9405 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9406 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9407
9408 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9409
9410 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9411
9412 Examples:
9413 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9414 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9415 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9416 option tcp-check
9417 tcp-check connect
9418 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9419 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9420 tcp-check send \r\n
9421 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9422 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9423 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9424 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9425 tcp-check send \r\n
9426 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9427 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9428
9429 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9430 option tcp-check
9431 tcp-check connect port 110
9432 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9433 tcp-check connect port 143
9434 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9435 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9436
9437 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9438
9439
9440tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009442 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9443 no | no | yes | yes
9444
9445 Arguments :
9446 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9447 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9448 binary.
9449 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9450 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9451 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9452
9453 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9454 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9455 with the usual backslash ('\').
9456 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009457 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009458 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9459 used upper or lower case.
9460
9461
9462 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9463
9464 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9465 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9466 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9467 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9468 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9469 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9470 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9471 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9472
9473 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9474 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9475 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9476 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9477 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9478 expression.
9479
9480 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9481 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9482 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9483 this exact hexadecimal string.
9484 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9485
9486 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9487 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9488 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9489 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9490 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9491 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9492 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9493 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9494 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9495 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9496 the null character.
9497
9498 Examples :
9499 # perform a POP check
9500 option tcp-check
9501 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9502
9503 # perform an IMAP check
9504 option tcp-check
9505 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9506
9507 # look for the redis master server
9508 option tcp-check
9509 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009510 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009511 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9512 tcp-check expect string role:master
9513 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9514 tcp-check expect string +OK
9515
9516
9517 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9518 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9519
9520
9521tcp-check send <data>
9522 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9523 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9524 no | no | yes | yes
9525
9526 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9527 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9528
9529 Examples :
9530 # look for the redis master server
9531 option tcp-check
9532 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9533 tcp-check expect string role:master
9534
9535 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9536 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9537
9538
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009539tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9540 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009541 tcp health check
9542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9543 no | no | yes | yes
9544
9545 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9546 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009547 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009548 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9549 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9550 hexadecimal string.
9551 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9552
9553 Examples :
9554 # redis check in binary
9555 option tcp-check
9556 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9557 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9558
9559
9560 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9561 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9562
9563
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009564tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9565 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9567 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009568 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009569 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9570 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009572 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009573
9574 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9575 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009576 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9577 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9578 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9579 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9580 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9581 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009583 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9584 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9585 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9586 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009587
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009588 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009589 - accept :
9590 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9591 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9592 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009594 - reject :
9595 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9596 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9597 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9598 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9599 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9600 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9601 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9602 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9603 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9604 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9605 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009606 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009607
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009608 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9609 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9610 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9611 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9612 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9613 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9614 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9615 hosts.
9616
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009617 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9618 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9619 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9620 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9621 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9622 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9623 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9624 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9625
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009626 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9627 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9628 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9629 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9630 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9631 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9632 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9633 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9634 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009635 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9636 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009637
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009638 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009639 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009640 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9641 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9642 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009643 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009644 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9645 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9646 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9647 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9648 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9649 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9650 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9651 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009652
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009653 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009654 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009656 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009657 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9658 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9659 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009660
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009661 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9662 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9663 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9664 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009665
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009666 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9667 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9668 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9669 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9670 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009671 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9672 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9673 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9674 layer7 information is extracted.
9675
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009676 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9677 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9678 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9679 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9680 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009681
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009682 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9683 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9684 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9685 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9686
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009687 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9688 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9689 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9690 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9691
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009692 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9693 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9694 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9695 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9696 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009697
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009698 - set-src <expr> :
9699 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9700 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9701 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009702 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009703
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009704 Arguments:
9705 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9706 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009707
9708 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009709 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9710
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009711 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9712 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009713
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009714 - set-src-port <expr> :
9715 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9716 expression.
9717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009718 Arguments:
9719 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9720 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009721
9722 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009723 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9724
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009725 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9726 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9727 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009728
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009729 - set-dst <expr> :
9730 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9731 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9732 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9733 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9734 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9735
9736 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9737 followed by some converters.
9738
9739 Example:
9740
9741 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9742 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9743
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009744 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9745 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9746
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009747 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9748 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9749 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9750 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9751
9752
9753 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9754 followed by some converters.
9755
9756 Example:
9757
9758 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9759
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009760 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9761 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9762 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9763
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009764 - "silent-drop" :
9765 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009767 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9768 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9769 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9770 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9771 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009772 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9773 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009774 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9775 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009776 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009777 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9778 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9779 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9780 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9781
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009782 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9783 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9784 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009785
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009786 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9787 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9788 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009789
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009790 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009791 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009792 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009793
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009794 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9795 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9796 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009797
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009798 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009799 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9800 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009801
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009802 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9803
9804 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9805
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009806 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9807
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009808 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009809
9810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009811tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9812 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009814 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009815 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009816 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9817 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009819 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009820
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009821 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009822 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9823 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9824 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9825 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009826
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009827 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9828 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9829 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9830 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009831 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9832 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9833 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9834 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9835 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9836 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009837 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009838 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009840 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9841 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9842 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9843 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009844
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009845 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009846 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009847 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009848 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9849 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009850 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009851 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009852 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009853 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009854 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009855 - set-dst <expr>
9856 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009857 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009858 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009859 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009860 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009861 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009862
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009863 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9864 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009865 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9866 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009867
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009868 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9869 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9870 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9871 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9872 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9873 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009875 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009876 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9877 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009878
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009879 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009880 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9881 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9882 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9883 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009884 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9885 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9886 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009887
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009888 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009889 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9890 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9891 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009892
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009893 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9894 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9895
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009896 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009897 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9898 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009899
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009900 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9901 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009902 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009903 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9904 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009905 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009906 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009907 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009908 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9909 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009910 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009911 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9912 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009913
9914 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9915 followed by some converters.
9916
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009917 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9918 <var-name>.
9919
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009920 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9921 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9922 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9923 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9924 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9925
9926 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9927 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9928 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9929 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9930 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9931 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9932 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9933 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9934 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9935 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9936 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9937
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009938 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9939 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9940 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9941 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9942 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9943
9944 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9945
9946 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9947
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009948 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9949 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9950 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9951 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9952 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9953 evaluated.
9954
9955 Example:
9956 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9957
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009958 Example:
9959
9960 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009961 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009962
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009963 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009964 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9965 # and reject everything else.
9966 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9967 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009968 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009969 tcp-request content reject
9970
9971 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009972 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9973 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9974 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009975 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009976
9977 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9978 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9979 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009980 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009981 tcp-request content reject
9982
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009983 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009984 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009985 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009986 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009987 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9988 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009989
9990 Example:
9991 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9992 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009993 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009995 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009996 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009997
9998 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009999 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010000 # protecting all our sites
10001 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010002 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10003 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010004 ...
10005 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10006
10007 backend http_dynamic
10008 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010009 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010010 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010011 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010012 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010013 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010014 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010016 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010017
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010018 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10019 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010020
10021
10022tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10023 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010025 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010026 Arguments :
10027 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10028 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10029 as explained at the top of this document.
10030
10031 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10032 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10033 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10034 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10035 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10036
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010037 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10038 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10039 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10040 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10041
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010042 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10043 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010044 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010045 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010046 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10047 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10048 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10049 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010050
10051 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10052 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10053 it pass through unaffected.
10054
10055 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10056 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10057 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010058 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010059 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10060 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010061 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10062 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10063 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010064
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010065 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010066 "timeout client".
10067
10068
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010069tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10070 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10072 no | no | yes | yes
10073 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010074 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10075 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010076
10077 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10078
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010079 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010080 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10081 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010082 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10083 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010084
10085 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10086
10087 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10088 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10089 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10090 inserted.
10091
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010092 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010093 - accept :
10094 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10095 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10096 the rules evaluation.
10097
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010098 - close :
10099 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10100 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10101 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10102 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10103 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10104 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010105 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010106 protocols.
10107
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010108 - reject :
10109 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10110 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010111 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010112
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010113 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10114 Sets a variable.
10115
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010116 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10117 Unsets a variable.
10118
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010119 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10120 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10121 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10122 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10123
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010124 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10125 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10126 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10127 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10128
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010129 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10130 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10131 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10132 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10133 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010134
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010135 - "silent-drop" :
10136 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010137 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010138 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10139 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10140 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10141 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10142 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010143 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10144 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010145 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10146 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010147 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010148 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10149 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10150 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10151 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10152
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010153 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10154 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10155
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010156 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10157 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10158 for changing the default action to a reject.
10159
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010160 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10161 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10162 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10163 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010164 period.
10165
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010166 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10167 declared inline.
10168
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010169 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10170 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010171 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010172 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10173 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010174 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010175 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010176 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010177 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10178 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010179 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010180 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10181 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010182
10183 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10184 followed by some converters.
10185
10186 Example:
10187
10188 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10189
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010190 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10191 <var-name>.
10192
10193 Example:
10194
10195 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10196
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010197 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10198 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10199 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10200 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10201 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10202
10203 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10204
10205 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10206
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010207 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10208
10209 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10210
10211
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010212tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10213 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10215 no | yes | yes | no
10216 Arguments :
10217 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10218 below.
10219
10220 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010222 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010223 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10224 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10225 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10226 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10227 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10228 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10229 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010230 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010231 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10232 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10233 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10234 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10235 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10236 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10237 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10238 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10239 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10240 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10241 instead.
10242
10243 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10244 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10245 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10246 rules which may be inserted.
10247
10248 Several types of actions are supported :
10249 - accept : the request is accepted
10250 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10251 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10252 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010253 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010254 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010255 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010256 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010257 - silent-drop
10258
10259 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10260 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10261 sections for a complete description.
10262
10263 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10264 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10265 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10266
10267 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10268 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10269 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10270 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10271 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10272
10273 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10274 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10275
10276 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10277 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10278 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10279
10280 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10281 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10282 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10283
10284 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10285 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10286 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10287
10288 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10289 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10290 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10291
10292 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10293
10294 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10295
10296
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010297tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10298 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10300 no | no | yes | yes
10301 Arguments :
10302 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10303 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10304 as explained at the top of this document.
10305
10306 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10307
10308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010309timeout check <timeout>
10310 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10311 established.
10312
10313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10314 yes | no | yes | yes
10315 Arguments:
10316 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10317 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10318 as explained at the top of this document.
10319
10320 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10321 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010322 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010323 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010324 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10325 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10326 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010327
10328 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10329 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10330
10331 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10332 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010333 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010334
10335 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10336 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10337 forget about it.
10338
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010339 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10340 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010341
10342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010343timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010344 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10346 yes | yes | yes | no
10347 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010348 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010349 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10350 as explained at the top of this document.
10351
10352 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10353 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10354 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010355 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10356 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10357 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10358 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010359 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10360 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10361 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010362 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010363 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010364 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10365 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010366 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10367 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010368
10369 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10370 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10371 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10372 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010373 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010374 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10375
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010376 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010377
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010378 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010380
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010381timeout client-fin <timeout>
10382 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10384 yes | yes | yes | no
10385 Arguments :
10386 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10387 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10388 as explained at the top of this document.
10389
10390 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10391 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10392 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10393 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10394 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10395 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10396 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010397 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10398 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10399 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010400
10401 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10402 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10403 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10404
10405 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10406
10407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010408timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010409 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10411 yes | no | yes | yes
10412 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010413 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010414 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10415 as explained at the top of this document.
10416
10417 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010418 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010419 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010420 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010421 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10422 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010423
10424 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10425 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10426 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10427 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010428 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010429 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10430
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010431 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010433
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010434timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10435 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10437 yes | yes | yes | yes
10438 Arguments :
10439 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10440 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10441 as explained at the top of this document.
10442
10443 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10444 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10445 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10446 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10447 once the request has started to present itself.
10448
10449 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10450 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10451 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10452 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10453 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10454
10455 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10456 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10457 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10458 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10459
10460 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10461 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010462 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010463 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10464 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010465 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010466
10467 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10468 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10469 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10470 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10471
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010472 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10473 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010474 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10475
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010476 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10477
10478
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010479timeout http-request <timeout>
10480 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010482 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010483 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010484 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010485 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10486 as explained at the top of this document.
10487
10488 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10489 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10490 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10491 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10492 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10493 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10494 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010495 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10496 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10497 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10498 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010499 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010500 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10501 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010502
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010503 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10504 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10505 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10506 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10507 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010508 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010509
10510 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10511 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010512 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010513 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10514 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10515
10516 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010517 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10518 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10519 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010520
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010521 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010522 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010523
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010524
10525timeout queue <timeout>
10526 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10528 yes | no | yes | yes
10529 Arguments :
10530 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10532 as explained at the top of this document.
10533
10534 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10535 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10536 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10537 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10538 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10539
10540 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10541 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10542 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10543 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10544
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010545 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010546
10547
10548timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010549 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10551 yes | no | yes | yes
10552 Arguments :
10553 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10554 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10555 as explained at the top of this document.
10556
10557 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10558 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10559 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10560 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10561 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10562 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10563 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10564
10565 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10566 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10567 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10568 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10569 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010570 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010571 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010572 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10573 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010574 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10575 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010576
10577 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10578 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10579 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10580 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010581 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010582 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10583
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010584 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010585
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010586
10587timeout server-fin <timeout>
10588 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10590 yes | no | yes | yes
10591 Arguments :
10592 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10593 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10594 as explained at the top of this document.
10595
10596 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10597 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10598 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10599 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10600 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10601 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10602 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10603 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10604 situations, it should not be needed.
10605
10606 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10607 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10608 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10609
10610 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10611
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010612
10613timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010614 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10616 yes | yes | yes | yes
10617 Arguments :
10618 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10619 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10620 as explained at the top of this document.
10621
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010622 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10623 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10624 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010625
10626 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10627 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10628 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10629 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010630 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010631
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010632 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010633
10634
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010635timeout tunnel <timeout>
10636 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10638 yes | no | yes | yes
10639 Arguments :
10640 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10641 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10642 as explained at the top of this document.
10643
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010644 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010645 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10646 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10647 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010648 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10649 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010650 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10651 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10652 specified.
10653
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010654 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10655 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10656 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10657 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10658 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10659 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10660 state.
10661
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010662 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10663 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10664 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10665 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010666 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010667
10668 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10669 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10670 forget about it.
10671
10672 Example :
10673 defaults http
10674 option http-server-close
10675 timeout connect 5s
10676 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010677 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010678 timeout server 30s
10679 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10680
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010681 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010682
10683
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010684transparent (deprecated)
10685 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010687 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010688 Arguments : none
10689
10690 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10691 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10692 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10693 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10694 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10695 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10696 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10697 appropriate server.
10698
10699 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10700
10701 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10702 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10703
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010704 See also: "option transparent"
10705
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010706unique-id-format <string>
10707 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10709 yes | yes | yes | no
10710 Arguments :
10711 <string> is a log-format string.
10712
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010713 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10714 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10715 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10716 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010717
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010718 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10719 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10720 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10721 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10722 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10723 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10724 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10725 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010726
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010727 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10728 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010729
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010730 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010731
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010732 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010733
10734 will generate:
10735
10736 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10737
10738 See also: "unique-id-header"
10739
10740unique-id-header <name>
10741 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10743 yes | yes | yes | no
10744 Arguments :
10745 <name> is the name of the header.
10746
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010747 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10748 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010749
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010750 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010751
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010752 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010753 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10754
10755 will generate:
10756
10757 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10758
10759 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010760
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010761use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010762 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10764 no | yes | yes | no
10765 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010766 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10767 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010768
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010769 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10770 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010771
10772 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10773 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10774 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010775 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010776 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010777 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10778 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010779
10780 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10781 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10782 assign the backend.
10783
10784 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10785 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10786 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10787 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10788 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10789 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10790
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010791 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010792 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010793 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10794 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10795 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10796
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010797 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10798 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10799 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10800 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10801 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10802 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10803 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10804 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10805 cannot be forced from the request.
10806
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010807 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010808 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10809 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10810
10811 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10812 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010813
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010814use-fcgi-app <name>
10815 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10817 no | no | yes | yes
10818 Arguments :
10819 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10820
10821 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010822
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010823use-server <server> if <condition>
10824use-server <server> unless <condition>
10825 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10827 no | no | yes | yes
10828 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010829 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010830
10831 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10832
10833 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10834 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10835 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10836
10837 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10838 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10839 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10840 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10841 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10842 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10843 matches will assign the server.
10844
10845 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10846 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10847 with the next rules until one matches.
10848
10849 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10850 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10851 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10852 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10853
10854 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10855 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10856 stripped.
10857
10858 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10859 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10860 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10861 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10862
10863 Example :
10864 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10865 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10866 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10867 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10868 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10869 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010870 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010871 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10872 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10873
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010874 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010875
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010876
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108775. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010878--------------------------
10879
10880The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10881depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10882settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10883written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10884described in this section.
10885
10886
108875.1. Bind options
10888-----------------
10889
10890The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10891as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10892no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10893parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10894while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10895provided immediately after the setting name.
10896
10897The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10898
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010899accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10900 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10901 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10902 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10903 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10904 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10905 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10906 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10907 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10908 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010909 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10910 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10911 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010912
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010913accept-proxy
10914 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010915 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10916 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010917 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10918 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10919 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10920 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010921 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010922 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10923 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010924 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10925 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010926
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010927allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010928 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010929 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010930 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010931 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10932 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010933
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010934alpn <protocols>
10935 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10936 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10937 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010938 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010939 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010940 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10941 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10942 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10943 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10944 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10945 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10946 preference, like below :
10947
10948 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010949
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010950backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010951 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010952 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10953
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010954curves <curves>
10955 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10956 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10957 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10958 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10959 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10960 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10961
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010962ecdhe <named curve>
10963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010964 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10965 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010966
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010967ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10969 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10970 client's certificate.
10971
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010972ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10973 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10974 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10975 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10976 error is ignored.
10977
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010978ca-sign-file <cafile>
10979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10980 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10981 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10982 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10983 'generate-certificates' for details.
10984
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010985ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010986 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10987 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10988 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10989 'generate-certificates' for details.
10990
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010991ciphers <ciphers>
10992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10993 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010994 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010995 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010996 information and recommendations see e.g.
10997 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10998 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10999 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11000
11001ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11002 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11003 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11004 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11005 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011006 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11007 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011008
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011009crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011010 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11011 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11012 to verify client's certificate.
11013
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011014crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11016 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11017 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11018 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11019 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11020 file.
11021
11022 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11023 are loaded.
11024
11025 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011026 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011027 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11028 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11029 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11030 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011031 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11032 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011033 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011034
11035 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11036 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11037 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11038 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011039 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11040 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011041
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011042 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011043
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011044 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011045 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011046 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11047 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011048 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11049 clients).
11050
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011051 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11052 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11053 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11054 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11055 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11056 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11057 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11058 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11059 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11060 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11061 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11062 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11063 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11064
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011065 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11066 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11067 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11068 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11069 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11070
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011071 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11072 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11073 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11074 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011075
11076 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11077 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11078 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11079 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11080 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11081 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11082 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11083 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11084 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11085
11086 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11087
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011088 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011089 a cert bundle.
11090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011091 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011092 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11093 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11094 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11095 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11096 provide multi-cert support.
11097
11098 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11099
11100 Filename | CN | SAN
11101 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11102 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011103 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011104 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11105 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11106
11107 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11108 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11109 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11110 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011111 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11112 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11113 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011114
11115 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11116 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11117
11118 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11119 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11120 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11121
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011122crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011124 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011125 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011126 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011127
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011128crt-list <file>
11129 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011130 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11131 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011132
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011133 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11134
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011135 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11136 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011137 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011138 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011139
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011140 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11141 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11142 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11143 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11144 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11145 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11146 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11147 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011148
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011149 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011150 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011151 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11152 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11153 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011154
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011155 crt-list file example:
11156 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011157 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011158 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011159 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011160
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011161defer-accept
11162 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11163 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11164 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011165 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011166 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11167 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11168 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11169 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11170 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11171 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11172 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11173
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011174expose-fd listeners
11175 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11176 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011177 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11178 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011179 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011180
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011181force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011182 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011183 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011184 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011185 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011186
11187force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011188 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011189 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011190 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011191
11192force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011193 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011194 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011195 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011196
11197force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011198 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011199 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011200 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011201
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011202force-tlsv13
11203 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11204 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011205 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011206
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011207generate-certificates
11208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11209 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11210 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11211 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11212 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11213 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11214 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11215 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11216 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11217 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11218 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11219
11220 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11221 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011222 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011223 certificate is used many times.
11224
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011225gid <gid>
11226 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11227 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11228 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11229 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11230 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11231
11232group <group>
11233 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11234 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11235 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11236 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11237 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11238
11239id <id>
11240 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11241 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11242 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11243 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11244
11245interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011246 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11247 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11248 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11249 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11250 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11251 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011252 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11253 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11254 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11255 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11256 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11257 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011258
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011259level <level>
11260 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11261 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11262 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011263 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011264 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11265 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11266 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011267 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011268 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011269 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011270 all counters).
11271
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011272severity-output <format>
11273 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11274 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11275 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11276 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11277 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11278 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11279 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11280 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11281 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11282 rfc5424 convention.
11283
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011284maxconn <maxconn>
11285 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11286 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11287 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11288 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11289 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11290 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11291 eat all memory.
11292
11293mode <mode>
11294 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11295 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11296 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11297 UNIX sockets.
11298
11299mss <maxseg>
11300 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11301 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11302 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11303 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11304 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11305 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11306 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11307 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11308 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11309 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11310 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11311
11312name <name>
11313 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11314 page.
11315
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011316namespace <name>
11317 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11318 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11319 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11320 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11321
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011322nice <nice>
11323 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11324 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11325 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11326 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11327 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11328 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11329 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11330 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11331 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11332 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11333 one for an RDP socket.
11334
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011335no-ca-names
11336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11337 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11338
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011339no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011341 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011342 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011343 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011344 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11345 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011346
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011347no-tls-tickets
11348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11349 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11350 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011351 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11352 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011353
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011354no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011356 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011357 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011358 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011359 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11360 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011361
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011362no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011364 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011365 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011366 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011367 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11368 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011369
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011370no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011372 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011373 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011374 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011375 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11376 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011377
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011378no-tlsv13
11379 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11380 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11381 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11382 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011383 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11384 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011385
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011386npn <protocols>
11387 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11388 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11389 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011390 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011391 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011392 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11393 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11394 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11395 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11396 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011397
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011398prefer-client-ciphers
11399 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11400 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11401 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011402 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11403 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11404 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011405
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011406process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011407 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011408 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011409 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011410 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11411 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11412 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11413 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011414 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011415 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11416 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11417 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11418 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11419 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011420
11421 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11422
11423 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11424 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11425 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11426 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11427 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11428 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11429 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11430 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011431
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011432proto <name>
11433 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11434 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11435 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11436 in haproxy -vv.
11437 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11438 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011439 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011440 h2" on the bind line.
11441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011442ssl
11443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011444 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011445 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11446 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011447 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11448 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011449
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011450ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11451 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11452 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11453 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11454
11455ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11456 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11457 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11458 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11459
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011460strict-sni
11461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11462 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11463 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11464 See the "crt" option for more information.
11465
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011466tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011467 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011468 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11469 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011470 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011471 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11472 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11473 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11474 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11475 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11476 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11477 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11478
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011479tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011480 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011481 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11482 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11483 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11484 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11485 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11486 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11487 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011488 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11489 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11490 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011491
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011492tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11493 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011494 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11495 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11496 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11497 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11498 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11499 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11500 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11501 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11502 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11503 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011504 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11505 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11506
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011507transparent
11508 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11509 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11510 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11511 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11512 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11513 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11514 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11515 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11516 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11517 so check for support with your vendor.
11518
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011519v4v6
11520 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11521 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11522 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11523 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011524 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011525
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011526v6only
11527 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11528 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11529 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011530 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11531 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011532
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011533uid <uid>
11534 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11535 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11536 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11537 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11538 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11539
11540user <user>
11541 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11542 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11543 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11544 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11545 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11546
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011547verify [none|optional|required]
11548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11549 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11550 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11551 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11552 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011553 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11554 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11555 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11556 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011557
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200115585.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011559------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011561The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11562which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11563arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11564settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11565after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11566Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11567address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011569 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011570 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011571
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011572Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11573keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011575The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011576
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011577addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011578 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011579 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11580 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11581 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11582 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11583 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011584
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011585agent-check
11586 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011587 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011588 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11589 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11590 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011591
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011592 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011593 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011594 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11595 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11596 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011598 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11599 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11600 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11601 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11602 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011603
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011604 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011605 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011606
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011607 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11608 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11609 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011610
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011611 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11612 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11613 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011614
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011615 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11616 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11617 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11618 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11619 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011620 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011621 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011622
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011623 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11624 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011625
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011626 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11627 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11628 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11629 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11630 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11631 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11632 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11633 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11634 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011635
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011636 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11637 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011638 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11639 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11640 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011641 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011642
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011643 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011644 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011645
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011646agent-send <string>
11647 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11648 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11649 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11650 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11651 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11652
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011653agent-inter <delay>
11654 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11655 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11656
11657 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11658 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11659 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11660 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11661 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11662 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11663 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11664 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11665 of backends use the same servers.
11666
11667 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11668
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011669agent-addr <addr>
11670 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11671
11672 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11673 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11674 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11675 hostname, it will be resolved.
11676
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011677agent-port <port>
11678 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11679
11680 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11681
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011682allow-0rtt
11683 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011684 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11685 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011686
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011687alpn <protocols>
11688 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11689 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11690 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011691 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011692 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11693 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11694 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11695 now obsolete NPN extension.
11696 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11697 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11698
11699 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011701backup
11702 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11703 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11704 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11705 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011706 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11707 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011708
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011709ca-file <cafile>
11710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11711 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11712 server's certificate.
11713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011714check
11715 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011716 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11717 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11718 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11719 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11720 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11721 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11722 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011723 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11724 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011725 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11726 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011727
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011728check-send-proxy
11729 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11730 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11731 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11732 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11733 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11734 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11735 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11736
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011737check-alpn <protocols>
11738 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11739 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11740 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11741
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011742check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011743 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011744 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11745 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011746
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011747check-ssl
11748 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11749 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11750 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11751 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011752 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011753 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11754 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011755 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011756 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11757 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011758
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011759check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011760 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011761 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11762 for normal traffic.
11763
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011764ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11766 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11767 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011768 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11769 information and recommendations see e.g.
11770 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11771 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11772 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011773
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011774ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11776 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11777 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11778 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011779 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11780 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11781 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011783cookie <value>
11784 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11785 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11786 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11787 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11788 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11789 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11790 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11791
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011792crl-file <crlfile>
11793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11794 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11795 to verify server's certificate.
11796
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011797crt <cert>
11798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11799 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11800 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11801 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11802 certificate request.
11803
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011804disabled
11805 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11806 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11807 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11808 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11809 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011810 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011811
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011812enabled
11813 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11814 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11815 default value.
11816 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11817 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011819error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011820 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11821 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11822 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011824 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011826fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011827 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11828 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11829 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11830
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011831force-sslv3
11832 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11833 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011834 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011835 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011836
11837force-tlsv10
11838 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011839 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011840 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011841
11842force-tlsv11
11843 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011844 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011845 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011846
11847force-tlsv12
11848 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011849 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011850 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011851
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011852force-tlsv13
11853 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11854 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011855 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011857id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011858 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11859 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11860 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011861
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011862init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11863 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11864 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011865 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011866 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11867 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11868 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11869 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11870 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11871 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11872 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11873 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11874 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011875 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011876 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11877 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11878 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11879 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11880 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11881 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011882 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011883
11884 Example:
11885 defaults
11886 # never fail on address resolution
11887 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011889inter <delay>
11890fastinter <delay>
11891downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011892 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11893 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11894 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11895 between checks depending on the server state :
11896
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011897 Server state | Interval used
11898 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11899 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11900 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11901 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11902 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11903 or yet unchecked. |
11904 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11905 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11906 | "inter" otherwise.
11907 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011909 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11910 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11911 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11912 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011913 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11914 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11915 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11916 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11917 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011919maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011920 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11921 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011922 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11923 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011924 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11925 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11926 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11927 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11928
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011929 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11930 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11931 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11932 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11933 than 50 concurrent requests.
11934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011935maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011936 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11937 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11938 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11939 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11940 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11941 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11942 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11943
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011944max-reuse <count>
11945 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11946 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11947 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11948 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11949 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11950 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11951 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11952 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011954minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011955 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11956 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11957 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11958 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11959 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11960 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011961 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011962 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011963
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011964namespace <name>
11965 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11966 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11967 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11968 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11969
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011970no-agent-check
11971 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11972 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11973 default value.
11974 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11975 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11976
11977no-backup
11978 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11979 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11980 default value.
11981 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11982 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11983
11984no-check
11985 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11986 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11987 default value.
11988 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11989 "default-server" "check" setting.
11990
11991no-check-ssl
11992 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11993 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11994 default value.
11995 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11996 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11997
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011998no-send-proxy
11999 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12000 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12001 default value.
12002 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12003 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12004
12005no-send-proxy-v2
12006 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12007 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12008 default value.
12009 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12010 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12011
12012no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12013 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12014 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12015 default value.
12016 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12017 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12018
12019no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12020 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12021 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12022 default value.
12023 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12024 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12025
12026no-ssl
12027 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12028 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12029 default value.
12030 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12031 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12032
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012033no-ssl-reuse
12034 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12035 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12036 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12037 and for paranoid users.
12038
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012039no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012040 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12041 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012042 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012043
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012044 Supported in default-server: No
12045
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012046no-tls-tickets
12047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12048 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12049 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012050 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12051 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012052 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012053
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012054no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012055 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012056 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12057 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012058 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12059 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012060 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012061
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012062 Supported in default-server: No
12063
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012064no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012065 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012066 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12067 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012068 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12069 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012070 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012071
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012072 Supported in default-server: No
12073
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012074no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012075 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012076 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12077 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012078 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12079 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012080 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012081
12082 Supported in default-server: No
12083
12084no-tlsv13
12085 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12086 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12087 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12088 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12089 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012090 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012091
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012092 Supported in default-server: No
12093
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012094no-verifyhost
12095 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12096 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12097 default value.
12098 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12099 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012100
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012101no-tfo
12102 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12103 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12104 default value.
12105 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12106 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12107
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012108non-stick
12109 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12110 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12111 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12112
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012113npn <protocols>
12114 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12115 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12116 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012117 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012118 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12119 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12120 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012122observe <mode>
12123 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12124 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12125 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12126 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12127 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12128 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012129 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012130
12131 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012133on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012134 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12135 Currently, four modes are available:
12136 - fastinter: force fastinter
12137 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12138 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12139 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12140 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12141
12142 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12143
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012144on-marked-down <action>
12145 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12146 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012147 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12148 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12149 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12150 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12151 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12152 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12153 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12154 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012155
12156 Actions are disabled by default
12157
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012158on-marked-up <action>
12159 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12160 Currently one action is available:
12161 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12162 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12163 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12164 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012165 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12166 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012167 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12168 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12169
12170 Actions are disabled by default
12171
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012172pool-max-conn <max>
12173 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12174 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12175 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12176 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12177 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12178 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12179
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012180pool-purge-delay <delay>
12181 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012182 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012183 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012184
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012185port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012186 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12187 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12188 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12189 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12190 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12191 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12192
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012193proto <name>
12194
12195 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12196 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12197 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12198 reported in haproxy -vv.
12199 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12200 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012202redir <prefix>
12203 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12204 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12205 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12206 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12207 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12208 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12209 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12210 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012211 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012212 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012213 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12214 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12215 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12216 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12217
12218 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012220rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012221 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12222 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12223 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12224
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012225resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12226 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12227 server.
12228
12229 Available options:
12230
12231 * allow-dup-ip
12232 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12233 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12234 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12235 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12236 For such case, simply enable this option.
12237 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12238
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012239 * ignore-weight
12240 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12241 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12242 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12243
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012244 * prevent-dup-ip
12245 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12246 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12247 same fqdn.
12248 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12249
12250 Example:
12251 backend b_myapp
12252 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12253 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12254 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12255
12256 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12257 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12258 it
12259 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12260 different address
12261
12262 Default value: not set
12263
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012264resolve-prefer <family>
12265 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12266 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12267 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12268 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12269
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012270 Default value: ipv6
12271
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012272 Example:
12273
12274 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012275
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012276resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012277 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012278 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012279 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012280 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12281 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012282 configured network, another address is selected.
12283
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012284 Example:
12285
12286 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012287
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012288resolvers <id>
12289 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12290 hostname.
12291
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012292 Example:
12293
12294 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012295
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012296 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012297
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012298send-proxy
12299 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12300 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12301 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12302 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012303 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12304 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12305 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12306 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12307 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12308 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12309 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12310 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12311 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12312 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012313 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12314 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012315
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012316send-proxy-v2
12317 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12318 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12319 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12320 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012321 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12322 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12323 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12324 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012325
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012326proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12327 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12328 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012329 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12330 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012331 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12332 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012333 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012334
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012335send-proxy-v2-ssl
12336 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12337 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12338 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12339 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12340 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12341 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12342 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012343 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12344 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012345
12346send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12347 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12348 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12349 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12350 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12351 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12352 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12353 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12354 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012355 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12356 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012358slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012359 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12360 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12361 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12362 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12363 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12364 parameters :
12365
12366 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12367 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12368
12369 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12370 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12371 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12372 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12373
12374 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12375 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12376 seen as failed.
12377
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012378sni <expression>
12379 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12380 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12381 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12382 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012383 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12384 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012385 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012386 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12387 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012388
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012389source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012390source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012391source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012392 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12393 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12394 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12395 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12396
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012397 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12398 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12399 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12400 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12401 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12402 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12403 server.
12404
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012405 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12406 specifying the source address without port(s).
12407
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012408ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012409 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12410 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12411 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12412 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12413 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12414 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012415 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12416 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012417
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012418ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12419 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12420 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12421 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12422
12423ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12424 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12425 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12426 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12427
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012428ssl-reuse
12429 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12430 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12431 default value.
12432 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12433 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12434
12435stick
12436 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12437 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12438 default value.
12439 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12440 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012441
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012442socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012443 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012444 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12445 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12446
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012447tcp-ut <delay>
12448 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12449 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12450 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012451 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012452 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12453 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12454 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12455 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12456 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12457 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12458 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12459 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12460 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12461
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012462tfo
12463 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12464 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12465 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12466 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12467 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012468 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012470track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012471 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12472 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12473 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12474 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012475 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12476
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012477tls-tickets
12478 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12479 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12480 default value.
12481 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12482 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012483
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012484verify [none|required]
12485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012486 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012487 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12488 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012489 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012490 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12491 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12492 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12493 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12494 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12495 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12496 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12497 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012498
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012499verifyhost <hostname>
12500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012501 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12502 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12503 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12504 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12505 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12506 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12507 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12508 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012510weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012511 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12512 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12513 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012514 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12515 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12516 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12517 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12518 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12519 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012520
12521
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125225.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12523-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012524
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012525HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12526using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12527configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012528This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12529can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12530workload.
12531This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12532resolution at run time.
12533Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12534carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12535
12536
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125375.3.1. Global overview
12538----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012539
12540As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12541different steps of the process life:
12542
12543 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12544 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12545 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12546
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012547 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12548 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012549
12550A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12551 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12552 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12553 resolution to know this new IP.
12554
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012555When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012556HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012557SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12558from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12559will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12560will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012561
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012562A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012563 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012564 first valid response.
12565
12566 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12567 servers return an error.
12568
12569
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125705.3.2. The resolvers section
12571----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012572
12573This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012574HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12575contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012576
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012577When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12578uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12579is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12580answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12581
12582When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012583used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012584
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012585 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12586 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12587 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012588
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012589 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12590 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012591
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012592 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12593 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12594 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012595
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012596For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12597following scenarios are possible:
12598
12599 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12600 ignored
12601
12602 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12603 applied
12604
12605 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12606 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12607
12608 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12609 retries the query with a new type
12610
12611 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12612 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012613
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012614As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12615a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012616<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012617
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012618
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012619resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012620 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012621
12622A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12623
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012624accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012625 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012626 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012627 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12628 by RFC 6891)
12629
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012630 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12631
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012632nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12633 DNS server description:
12634 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12635 <ip> : IP address of the server
12636 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12637
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012638parse-resolv-conf
12639 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12640 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12641 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12642
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012643hold <status> <period>
12644 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12645 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012646 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012647 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012648 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12649 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12650 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12651
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012652 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012653
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012654resolve_retries <nb>
12655 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12656 giving up.
12657 Default value: 3
12658
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012659 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12660 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12661 type.
12662
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012663timeout <event> <time>
12664 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12665 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12666 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012667 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12668 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012669 Default value: 1s
12670 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012671 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012672 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012673 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12674 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12675
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012676 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012677
12678 resolvers mydns
12679 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12680 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012681 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012682 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012683 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012684 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012685 hold other 30s
12686 hold refused 30s
12687 hold nx 30s
12688 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012689 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012690 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012691
12692
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200126936. Cache
12694---------
12695
12696HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12697(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12698RAM.
12699
12700The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12701this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12702
12703If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12704independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12705when we try to allocate a new one.
12706
12707The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12708
12709It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12710"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12711for more details.
12712
12713When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12714replaced by "<CACHE>".
12715
12716
127176.1. Limitation
12718----------------
12719
12720The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12721
12722- If the response is not a 200
12723- If the response contains a Vary header
12724- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12725- If the response is not cacheable
12726
12727- If the request is not a GET
12728- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12729- If the request contains an Authorization header
12730
12731
127326.2. Setup
12733-----------
12734
12735To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12736the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12737
12738
127396.2.1. Cache section
12740---------------------
12741
12742cache <name>
12743 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12744 size of cache is mandatory.
12745
12746total-max-size <megabytes>
12747 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12748 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12749
12750max-object-size <bytes>
12751 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12752 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12753 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12754
12755max-age <seconds>
12756 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12757 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12758 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12759 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12760 default.
12761
12762
127636.2.2. Proxy section
12764---------------------
12765
12766http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12767 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12768 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12769 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12770 after this one.
12771
12772http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12773 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12774 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12775 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12776 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12777
12778
12779Example:
12780
12781 backend bck1
12782 mode http
12783
12784 http-request cache-use foobar
12785 http-response cache-store foobar
12786 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12787
12788 cache foobar
12789 total-max-size 4
12790 max-age 240
12791
12792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127937. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12794----------------------------------
12795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012796HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12798The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12799these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12800but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12801data called patterns.
12802
12803
128047.1. ACL basics
12805---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012806
12807The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12808content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12809from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12810simple :
12811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012812 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012813 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12815 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12818adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012819
12820In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012823
12824This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12825Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12826and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012827an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12828conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12829as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12830are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012831
12832ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12833'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12834which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12835
12836There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12837performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12840specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12841this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012842methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12843ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844
12845Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12846 - boolean
12847 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12848 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12849 - string
12850 - data block
12851
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012852Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12853converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12854would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12855The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12856which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12857
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012858Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12859keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12860fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12861which are summarized in the table below :
12862
12863 +---------------------+-----------------+
12864 | Sample or converter | Default |
12865 | output type | matching method |
12866 +---------------------+-----------------+
12867 | boolean | bool |
12868 +---------------------+-----------------+
12869 | integer | int |
12870 +---------------------+-----------------+
12871 | ip | ip |
12872 +---------------------+-----------------+
12873 | string | str |
12874 +---------------------+-----------------+
12875 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12876 +---------------------+-----------------+
12877
12878Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12879matching method, see below.
12880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12882 - boolean
12883 - integer or integer range
12884 - IP address / network
12885 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12886 - regular expression
12887 - hex block
12888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012889The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12890
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012891 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12892 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012894 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012895 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012896 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012897 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12900read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12901if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12902lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12903will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12904beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12905a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12906lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12907exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12908
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012909The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12910parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12911ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12912a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12913check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12914
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012915The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12916socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12917file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012919Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12920loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12921
12922 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12923
12924In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12925the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12926case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12927as well.
12928
12929The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12930sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12931do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12932methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12933is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012934obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012935followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12936default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12937that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12938string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12939
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012940The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12941By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12942string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12943resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12944server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012945waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012946flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12947function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12950sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12951be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012952
12953 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12954 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12956 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12957 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12958 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012959
12960 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12961 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012962 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012963
12964 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012966
12967 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012969
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012970 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012971 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12972
12973 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12974 binary or string samples.
12975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012976 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12977 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012979 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12980 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12981 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012983 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12984 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012986 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12987 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12990 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012992 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12993 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012994 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012996 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12997 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12998 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012999
13000For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13001request, it is possible to do :
13002
13003 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13004
13005In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13006buffer, one would use the following acl :
13007
13008 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13009
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013010On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13011possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13012
13013 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013015All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13016criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13017method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13018to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13019criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13020the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013022If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013023the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13024For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013026 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13027 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13028 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13029 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013030
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013031
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013032The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13033types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13034combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13035brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13036default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038 +-------------------------------------------------+
13039 | Input sample type |
13040 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013041 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13043 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13044 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013045 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013046 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013047 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013048 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013049 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013050 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013051 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013053 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013054 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013055 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013057 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013058 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013059 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013061 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013063 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013065 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13067 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13068 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013069
13070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130717.1.1. Matching booleans
13072------------------------
13073
13074In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13075Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13076When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13077that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13078
13079Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13080return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13081"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130847.1.2. Matching integers
13085------------------------
13086
13087Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13088enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13089to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13090
13091Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13092matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13093lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013094
13095For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13096unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13097representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13098
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013099As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13100two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13101instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13102ranges and operators.
13103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013104For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013105operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13106Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13107of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013109Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013110
13111 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13112 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13113 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13114 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13115 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013117For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013118
13119 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13120
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013121This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13122
13123 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13124
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131267.1.3. Matching strings
13127-----------------------
13128
13129String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13130different forms :
13131
13132 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013133 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013134
13135 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013136 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013137
13138 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13139 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13140
13141 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13142 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13143
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013144 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13146 matches.
13147
13148 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13149 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13150 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013151
13152String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13153exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13154characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13155string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13156to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013157before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013158
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013159Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13160(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13161Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13162
13163Example:
13164 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13165 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13166
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131687.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13169---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013170
13171Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13172they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13173possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13174passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13175the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013176the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13177match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013178
13179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13181-------------------------------------
13182
13183It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13184not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13185a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13186to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13187digits may be used upper or lower case.
13188
13189Example :
13190 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13191 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13192
13193
131947.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13195---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013196
13197IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13198netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13199within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013200host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013201difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13202at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13203does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13204parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013205
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013206The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13207abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13208
13209 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13210 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13211 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13212 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13213 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13214 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13215 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13216 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13217
13218Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13219192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13220
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013221IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13222Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13223trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13224IPv6 patterns.
13225
13226HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13227following situations :
13228 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13229 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13230 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13231 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13232 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13233 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13234 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13235 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13236 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13237 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239
132407.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13241----------------------------------
13242
13243Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13244combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13245
13246 - AND (implicit)
13247 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13248 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013252 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013254Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13255indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13258"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13259requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13260is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13261
13262 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013263 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13264 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13265 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266
13267To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13268and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13269
13270 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13271 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13272 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13273 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013275 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13277 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13278 use_backend www if host_www
13279
13280It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13281expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13282be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13283the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13284
13285 The following rule :
13286
13287 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013288 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013289
13290 Can also be written that way :
13291
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013292 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293
13294It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13295to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13296simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13297sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13298good use is the following :
13299
13300 With named ACLs :
13301
13302 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13303 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13304 monitor fail if site_dead
13305
13306 With anonymous ACLs :
13307
13308 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13309
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013310See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13311keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013312
13313
133147.3. Fetching samples
13315---------------------
13316
13317Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13318against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13319sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13320ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13321of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13322available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13323
13324This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13325Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13326compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13327deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13328
13329The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13330matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13331method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13332indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13333
13334As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13335when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13336mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13337the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13338ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13339
13340Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13341multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13342when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013343incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13344are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013345is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13346all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13347
13348Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13349 - name
13350 - name(arg1)
13351 - name(arg1,arg2)
13352
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013353
133547.3.1. Converters
13355-----------------
13356
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013357Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13358of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13359is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13360was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013362unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13363
13364These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13365sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13366the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013367support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013368
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013369A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13370support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13371supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13372(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13373bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013376
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001337751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13378 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13379 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13380 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13381 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13382 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13383
13384 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013385 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13386 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013387 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13388 frontend http-in
13389 bind *:8081
13390 default_backend servers
13391 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13392 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13393
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013394add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013395 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013396 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013397 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13398 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013399 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013400 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13401 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13402 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13403 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013405 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013406
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013407aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13408 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13409 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13410 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13411 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13412 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13413 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13414
13415 Example:
13416 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13417 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13418
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013419and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013420 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013421 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013422 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13423 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013424 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013425 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13426 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13427 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13428 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013429 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013430 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013431
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013432b64dec
13433 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13434 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13435
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013436base64
13437 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013438 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013439 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13440
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013441bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013442 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013443 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013444 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013445 presence of a flag).
13446
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013447bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13448 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13449 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013450 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013451
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013452concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13453 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13454 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13455 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13456 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13457 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13458 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13459 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13460 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13461 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13462 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013463 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013464 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013465 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013466
13467 Example:
13468 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13469 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13470 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13471 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13472
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013473cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013474 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13475 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013476
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013477crc32([<avalanche>])
13478 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13479 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13480 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13481 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13482 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13483 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13484 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13485 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13486 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13487 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013488 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13489
13490crc32c([<avalanche>])
13491 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13492 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13493 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13494 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13495 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13496 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13497 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13498 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013499
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013500da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013501 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13502 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13503 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13504 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013505 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013506 configuration language.
13507
13508 Example:
13509 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013510 bind *:8881
13511 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013512 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013513
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013514debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13515 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13516 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13517 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13518 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13519 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13520 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13521 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13522 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13523 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13524 printable sample types.
13525
13526 Example:
13527 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013528
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013529div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013530 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13531 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013532 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013533 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13534 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013535 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013536 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13537 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13538 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13539 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013541 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013542
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013543djb2([<avalanche>])
13544 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13545 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13546 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13547 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13548 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13549 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13550 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013551 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13552 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013553
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013554even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013555 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013556 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13557
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013558field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13559 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13560 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13561 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13562 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13563 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13564 fields.
13565
13566 Example :
13567 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13568 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13569 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13570 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13571 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013573hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013574 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013575 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013576 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013577 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013578
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013579hex2i
13580 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013581 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013582
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013583http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013584 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13585 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013586 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13587 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13588 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13589 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13590 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13591 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13592 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13593 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013594
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013595in_table(<table>)
13596 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13597 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13598 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013599 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013600 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13601
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013602ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13603 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013604 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013605 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13606 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13607 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13608 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13609 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013610
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013611json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013612 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013613 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013614 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013615 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13616 of errors:
13617 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13618 bytes, ...)
13619 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13620 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13621
13622 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13623 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13624 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13625 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13626 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13627 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013628 - "ascii" : never fails;
13629 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13630 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013631 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013632 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013633 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13634 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13635
13636 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013638
13639 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013640 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013641 capture request header user-agent len 150
13642 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013643
13644 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13645 GET / HTTP/1.0
13646 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13647
13648 Output log:
13649 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13650
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013651language(<value>[,<default>])
13652 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13653 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13654 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13655 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13656 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13657 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13658 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13659 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13660 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013661 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013662 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13663 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013664
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013665 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013666
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013667 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13668 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013669
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013670 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13671 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13672 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13673 use_backend spanish if es
13674 use_backend french if fr
13675 use_backend english if en
13676 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013677
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013678length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013679 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13680 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13681 type. The result is of type integer.
13682
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013683lower
13684 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13685 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13686 type. The result is of type string.
13687
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013688ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13689 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13690 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13691 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13692 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13693 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13694 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13695
13696 Example :
13697
13698 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013699 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013700 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13701
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013702map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13703map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13704map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13705 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13706 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13707 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13708 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13709 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13710 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13711 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13712 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013713
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013714 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13715 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13716 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013717
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013718 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013719 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013720
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013721 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13722 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13723 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13724 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013725 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13726 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013727 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13728 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13729 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13730 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13731 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13732 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13733 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13734 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013735 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13736 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13737 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013738 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13739 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13740 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13741 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13742 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013743
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013744 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13745 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13746 the corresponding match text.
13747
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013748 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13749 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13750 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13751 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13752 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013754 Example :
13755
13756 # this is a comment and is ignored
13757 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13758 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13759 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13760 | | | `---------- value
13761 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13762 | `---------------------------- key
13763 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13764
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013765mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013766 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13767 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013768 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013769 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013770 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013771 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13772 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13773 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13774 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013775 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013776 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013777
13778mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013779 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013780 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13781 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013782 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013783 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13786 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13787 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13788 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013789 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013790 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013791
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013792nbsrv
13793 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13794 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13795 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13796 map lookup.
13797
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013798neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013799 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13800 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13801 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13802 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013803
13804not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013805 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013806 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013807 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013808 absence of a flag).
13809
13810odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013811 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013812 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13813
13814or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013815 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013816 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013817 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13818 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013819 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013820 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13821 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13822 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13823 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013825 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013826
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013827protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13828 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13829 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13830 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13831 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13832 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13833 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13834 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13835 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13836 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13837 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13838 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13839
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013840regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013841 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13842 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13843 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13844 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13845 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13846 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13847 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13848 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13849 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13850 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013851 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13852 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13853 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13854 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013855
13856 Example :
13857
13858 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13859 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13860 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13861 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13862
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013863capture-req(<id>)
13864 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13865 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13866
13867 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013868 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13869 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013870
13871capture-res(<id>)
13872 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13873 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13874
13875 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013876 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13877 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013878
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013879sdbm([<avalanche>])
13880 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13881 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13882 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13883 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13884 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13885 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13886 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013887 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13888 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013889
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013890set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013891 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13892 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13893 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013894 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013895 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13896 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013897 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013898 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13899 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013900 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013901 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013902
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013903sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013904 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013905 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13906
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013907sha2([<bits>])
13908 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13909 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13910
13911 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13912 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13913
13914 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13915 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13916
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013917srv_queue
13918 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13919 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13920 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13921 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13922 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13923
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013924strcmp(<var>)
13925 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13926 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13927 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13928 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13929 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13930 shorter).
13931
13932 Example :
13933
13934 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13935 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13936 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13937
13938
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013939sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013940 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13941 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013942 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013943 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13944 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013945 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013946 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13947 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013948 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013949 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013952 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013953
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013954table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13957 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13958 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13959 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13960 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13961
13962
13963table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13964 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13965 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13966 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13967 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13968 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13969 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13970
13971table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013974 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013975 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13976 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13977
13978table_conn_cur(<table>)
13979 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13980 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13981 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13982 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13983 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13984
13985table_conn_rate(<table>)
13986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13989 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13990 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13991
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013992table_gpt0(<table>)
13993 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13994 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13995 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13996 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13997 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13998
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013999table_gpc0(<table>)
14000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14003 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14004 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14005
14006table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14007 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14008 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14009 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14010 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14011 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14012 sample fetch keyword.
14013
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014014table_gpc1(<table>)
14015 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14016 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14017 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14018 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14019 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14020
14021table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14022 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14023 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14024 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14025 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14026 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14027 sample fetch keyword.
14028
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014029table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014033 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14034 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14035
14036table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14039 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14040 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14041 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14042 keyword.
14043
14044table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14045 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14046 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014047 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014048 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14049 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14050
14051table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14052 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14053 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14054 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14055 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14056 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14057 keyword.
14058
14059table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14060 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14061 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014062 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014063 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14064 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14065 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14066 keyword.
14067
14068table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014071 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014072 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14073 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14074 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14075 keyword.
14076
14077table_server_id(<table>)
14078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14080 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14081 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14082 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14083 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14084
14085table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014088 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014089 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14090 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14091 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14092 keyword.
14093
14094table_sess_rate(<table>)
14095 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14096 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14097 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14098 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14099 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14100 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14101 keyword.
14102
14103table_trackers(<table>)
14104 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14105 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14106 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14107 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14108 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14109 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14110 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14111 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14112 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14113 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14114
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014115upper
14116 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14117 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14118 type. The result is of type string.
14119
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014120url_dec
14121 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14122 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14123
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014124ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014125 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014126 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14127 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14128 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014129 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14130 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14131 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14132 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014133 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014134 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14135 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014136
14137 Example:
14138 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14139 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14140
14141 message Point {
14142 int32 latitude = 1;
14143 int32 longitude = 2;
14144 }
14145
14146 message PPoint {
14147 Point point = 59;
14148 }
14149
14150 message Rectangle {
14151 // One corner of the rectangle.
14152 PPoint lo = 48;
14153 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14154 PPoint hi = 49;
14155 }
14156
14157 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14158 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14159 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14160
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014161 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14162 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014163 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014164 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14165
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014166 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014167
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014168 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014169
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014170 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014171 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14172 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14173
14174 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14175 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14176 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14177
14178 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14179 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14180 interpret the previous binary sample.
14181
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014182
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014183unset-var(<var name>)
14184 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14185 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14186 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14187 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14188 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14189 response),
14190 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14191 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14192 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14193 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14194
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014195utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14196 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14197 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14198 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14199 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14200 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14201 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14202
14203 Example :
14204
14205 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014206 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014207 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14208
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014209word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14210 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14211 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14212 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014213 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014214 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14215 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14216
14217 Example :
14218 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14219 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14220 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14221 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14222 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014223 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014224
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014225wt6([<avalanche>])
14226 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14227 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14228 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14229 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14230 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14231 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14232 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014233 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14234 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014235
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014236xor(<value>)
14237 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014238 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014239 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014240 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014241 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014242 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14243 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014244 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014245 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14246 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014247 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014248 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014249
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014250xxh32([<seed>])
14251 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14252 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14253 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14254 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14255 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14256 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14257 as cryptographically secure.
14258
14259xxh64([<seed>])
14260 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14261 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14262 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14263 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14264 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14265 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14266 as cryptographically secure.
14267
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014268
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142697.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270--------------------------------------------
14271
14272A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14273not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14274"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14275The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14276
14277always_false : boolean
14278 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14279 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14280
14281always_true : boolean
14282 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14283 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14284
14285avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014286 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14288 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14289 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14290 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14291 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14292 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14293 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14294 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14295 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14296 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14297 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14298 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14299 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014301be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014302 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14303 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14304 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14305 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014306 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14307
14308be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14309 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14310 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14311 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14312 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14313 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014314 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14315 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014316
14317 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14318 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14319 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14322 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14323 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14324 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14327 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014328
14329 Example :
14330 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14331 backend dynamic
14332 mode http
14333 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14334 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014335
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014336bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014337 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14338 of the string.
14339
14340bool(<bool>) : bool
14341 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14342 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014344connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14345 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014346 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14348 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014349
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014350 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014351 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014352 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14353
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014354 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14355 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014356
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014357 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014358 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014360 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014361 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014362 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014363 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014364
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014365 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14366 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014367 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014368 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014369
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014370cpu_calls : integer
14371 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14372 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14373 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14374 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14375 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14376 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14377
14378cpu_ns_avg : integer
14379 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14380 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14381 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14382 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14383 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14384 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14385 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14386 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14387 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14388 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14389 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14390
14391cpu_ns_tot : integer
14392 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14393 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14394 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14395 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14396 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14397 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14398 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14399 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14400 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14401 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14402 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14403 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14404 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14405
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014406date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014407 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014408
14409 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14410 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14411 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014412 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14413
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014414 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14415 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14416 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14417 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14418 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14419
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014420 Example :
14421
14422 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14423 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014424
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014425 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14426 # millisecond granularity
14427 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14428
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014429date_us : integer
14430 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14431 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14432 from the same timeval structure.
14433
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014434distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14435 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14436 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14437 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14438 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14439 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14440 list of supported tokens.
14441
14442distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14443 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14444 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14445 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14446 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14447 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14448 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14449 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14450 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14451 supported tokens.
14452
14453 Example :
14454 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14455 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14456 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14457 # send large files to the big farm
14458 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14459
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014460env(<name>) : string
14461 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14462 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14463 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14464 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14465 certain way.
14466
14467 Examples :
14468 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14469 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14470
14471 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14472 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14475 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014476 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14477 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014478 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14479 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014480 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14482 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014483
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014484fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14485 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14486 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14487 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014489fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14490 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14491 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14492 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14493 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14494 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14495 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14496 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14497 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014498
14499 Example :
14500 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14501 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14502 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14503 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14504 frontend mail
14505 bind :25
14506 mode tcp
14507 maxconn 100
14508 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14509 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14510 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14511 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014512
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014513hostname : string
14514 Returns the system hostname.
14515
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014516int(<integer>) : signed integer
14517 Returns a signed integer.
14518
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014519ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14520 Returns an ipv4.
14521
14522ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14523 Returns an ipv6.
14524
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014525lat_ns_avg : integer
14526 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14527 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14528 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14529 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14530 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14531 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14532 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14533 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14534 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14535 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14536 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14537 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14538 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14539 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14540
14541lat_ns_tot : integer
14542 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14543 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14544 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14545 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14546 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14547 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14548 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14549 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14550 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14551 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14552 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14553 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14554 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14555 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14556 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14557 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14558 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14559 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14560 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14561
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014562meth(<method>) : method
14563 Returns a method.
14564
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014565nbproc : integer
14566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14567 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14568 and debugging purposes.
14569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14571 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14572 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14573 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014574 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14575 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14576 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014577
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014578prio_class : integer
14579 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14580 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14581 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14582
14583prio_offset : integer
14584 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14585 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14586 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14587 set-priority-offset".
14588
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014589proc : integer
14590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14591 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14592 debugging purposes.
14593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014594queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014595 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14596 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14597 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14599 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14600 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14601 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14602 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14603
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014604rand([<range>]) : integer
14605 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14606 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14607 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14608 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14609 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14610
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014611uuid([<version>]) : string
14612 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14613 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14614 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14618 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14619 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14620 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14621 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014622 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14623 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14624
14625srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14627 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14628 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14629 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14630 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14631 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14632 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14633
14634 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14635 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636
14637srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14638 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14639 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14640 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014641 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014642 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14643 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14644 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14645
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014646srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14648 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14649 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14650 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14651 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14652 fetch methods.
14653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14655 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14656 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014657 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014658 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14659 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014660 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661 overloading servers).
14662
14663 Example :
14664 # Redirect to a separate back
14665 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14666 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14667 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14668
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014669stopping : boolean
14670 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14671 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14672 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14673
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014674str(<string>) : string
14675 Returns a string.
14676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014677table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14678 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14679 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14680
14681table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14682 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14683 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14684 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14685
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014686thread : integer
14687 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14688 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14689 and debugging purposes.
14690
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014691var(<var-name>) : undefined
14692 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014693 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14694 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014698 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014699 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14700 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014701 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014702 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014703
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147047.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014705----------------------------------
14706
14707The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14708closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14709methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14710sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14711TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014712the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14713counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014714"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14715used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14716can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14717Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14718table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14719tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14720currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014722bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014723 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14724 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14725 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014727be_id : integer
14728 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14729 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14730
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014731be_name : string
14732 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14733 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735dst : ip
14736 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14737 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14738 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14739 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014740 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14741 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14742 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14743 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14744 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14745 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746
14747dst_conn : integer
14748 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14749 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14750 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14751 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14752 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14753 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14754 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14755 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014756
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014757dst_is_local : boolean
14758 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14759 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14760 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14761 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014762 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014763 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14764 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14765 it only once per connection.
14766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767dst_port : integer
14768 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14769 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14770 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14771 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14772 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14773 an HTTP header.
14774
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014775fc_http_major : integer
14776 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14777 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14778 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14779
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014780fc_pp_authority : string
14781 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14782 if any.
14783
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014784fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14785 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14786 header.
14787
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014788fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14789 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14790 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14791 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14792 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14793 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14794 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14795
14796fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14797 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14798 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14799 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14800 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14801 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14802 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14803
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014804fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014805 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14806 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14807 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14808 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14809
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014810fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014811 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14812 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14813 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14814 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14815
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014816fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014817 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14818 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14819 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14820 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14821
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014822fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014823 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14824 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14825 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14826 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14827
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014828fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014829 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14830 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14831 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14832 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14833
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014834fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014835 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14836 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14837 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14838 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14839
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014840fe_defbe : string
14841 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14842 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844fe_id : integer
14845 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014846 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014847 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14848
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014849fe_name : string
14850 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14851 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14852 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14853
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014854sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014855sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14856sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14857sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014858 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14859 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14860 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014862sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014863sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14864sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14865sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014866 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14867 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14868 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14869
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014870sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014871sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14872sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14873sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014874 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14875 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014876 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14877 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14878 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014879
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014880 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014881 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14882 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014883 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14884 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14885 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014886 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14887 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14888
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014889sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14890sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14891sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14892sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14893 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14894 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14895 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14896 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14897 when a first ACL was verified.
14898
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014899sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014900sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14901sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14902sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014903 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014904 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14905
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014906sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014907sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14908sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14909sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014910 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14911 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14912 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14913
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014914sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014915sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14916sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14917sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014918 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14919 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14920 See also src_conn_rate.
14921
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014922sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014923sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14924sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14925sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014926 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014927 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014928
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014929sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14930sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14931sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14932sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14933 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14934 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14935
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014936sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14937sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14938sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14939sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14940 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14941 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14942
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014943sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014944sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14945sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14946sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014947 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14948 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14949 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014950 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14951 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14952 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014953
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014954sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14955sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14956sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14957sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14958 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14959 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14960 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14961 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14962 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14963 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14964
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014965sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014966sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14967sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14968sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014970 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14971 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014973sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014974sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14975sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14976sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014977 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14978 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14979 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14980 src_http_err_rate.
14981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014982sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014983sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14984sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14985sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014986 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014987 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14988 src_http_req_cnt.
14989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014990sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014991sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14992sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14993sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014994 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14995 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14996 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14997 src_http_req_rate.
14998
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014999sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015000sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15001sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15002sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015003 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015004 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15005 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15006 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15007 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015008
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015009 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015010 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15011 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015012 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15013
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015014sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15015sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15016sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15017sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15018 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15019 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15020 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15021 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15022 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015024sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015025sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15026sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15027sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015028 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15029 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15030 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015032sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015033sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15034sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15035sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015036 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15037 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15038 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015039
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015040sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015041sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15042sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15043sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015044 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015045 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15046 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15047 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015048 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015049 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15050
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015051sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015052sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15053sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15054sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015055 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15056 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15057 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15058 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15059 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015060 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015061
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015062sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015063sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15064sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15065sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015066 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15067 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15068 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15069
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015070sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015071sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15072sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15073sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015074 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15075 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015076 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015077 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15078 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15080 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15081 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083so_id : integer
15084 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15085 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15086 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015089 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15091 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15092 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015093 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15094 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15095 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015096 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15097 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15098 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15099 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15100 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15101 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15102 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015103
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015104 Example:
15105 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15106 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015108src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15109 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15110 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15111 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015112 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15115 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15116 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015117 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015118 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15121 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15122 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15123 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15124 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15125 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15126 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015127
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015128 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015129 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15130 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15131 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15132 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015133 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015134 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15135 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15136
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015137src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15138 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15139 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15140 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15141 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15142 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15143 was verified.
15144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015146 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015147 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015148 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015149 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015152 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15154 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015155 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15158 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15159 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15160 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015161 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015164 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015165 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015166 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015167 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015168
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015169src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15170 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15171 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15172 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15173 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15174
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015175src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15176 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15177 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15178 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15179 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015182 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015184 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15185 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015186 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15187 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15188 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015189
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015190src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15191 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15192 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15193 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15194 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15195 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15196 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15197 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015200 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015202 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015203 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015204 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15207 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15208 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15209 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15210 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015211 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015214 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15216 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015217 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015219src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15220 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15221 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15222 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015223 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015224 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15227 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15228 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15229 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015230 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15232 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015233
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015234 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015235 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015236 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015237 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015238
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015239src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15240 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15241 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15242 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15243 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15244 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15245 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15246
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015247src_is_local : boolean
15248 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15249 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15250 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15251 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015252 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015253 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15254 once per connection.
15255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015257 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15258 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15259 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15260 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15261 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015263src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015264 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15265 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15266 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15267 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15268 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270src_port : integer
15271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15272 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15273 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15274 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015277 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015278 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15279 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15280 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015281 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015283src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15284 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15285 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15286 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15287 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015288 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15291 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15292 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15293 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15294 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15295 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15296 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15297 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15298 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015299
15300 Example :
15301 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15302 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15303 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15304 listen ssh
15305 bind :22
15306 mode tcp
15307 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015308 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015310 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312srv_id : integer
15313 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15314 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15315 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015316
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015317srv_name : string
15318 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15319 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15320 debugging.
15321
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153227.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15326closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15327when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15328usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015329future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015330
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001533151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15332 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15333 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15334 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15335 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15336 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15337
15338 Example :
15339 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15340 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15341 # the request.
15342 frontend http-in
15343 bind *:8081
15344 default_backend servers
15345 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15346 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15347
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015348ssl_bc : boolean
15349 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15350 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15351 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15352
15353ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15354 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15355 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15356
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015357ssl_bc_alpn : string
15358 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15359 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015360 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015361 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15362 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15363 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15364 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15365 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15366 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15367
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015368ssl_bc_cipher : string
15369 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15370 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15371
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015372ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15373 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15374 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15375 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15376
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015377ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15378 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15379 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15380 session or a TLS ticket.
15381
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015382ssl_bc_npn : string
15383 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15384 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015385 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015386 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15387 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15388 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15389 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15390 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15391
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015392ssl_bc_protocol : string
15393 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15394 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15395
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015396ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015397 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015398 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15399 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015400
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015401ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15402 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15403 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15404 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15405
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015406ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15407 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15408 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15409 if session was reused or not.
15410
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015411ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15412 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15413 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15414 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15415 BoringSSL.
15416
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015417ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15418 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15419 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15422 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15423 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15424 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15425 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15426 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015428ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15429 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15430 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15431 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15432 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015433
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015434ssl_c_der : binary
15435 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15436 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15437 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439ssl_c_err : integer
15440 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15441 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15442 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15443 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15444 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015445
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015446ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015447 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15448 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15449 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15450 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15451 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15452 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15453 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15454 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015455 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15456 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15457 LDAP v3.
15458 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15459 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461ssl_c_key_alg : string
15462 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15463 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15464 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466ssl_c_notafter : string
15467 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15468 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15469 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015471ssl_c_notbefore : string
15472 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15473 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15474 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015475
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015476ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15478 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15479 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15480 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15481 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15482 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15483 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15484 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015485 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15486 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15487 LDAP v3.
15488 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15489 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491ssl_c_serial : binary
15492 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15493 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15494 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15497 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15498 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15499 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015500 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15501 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15502
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015503 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015504 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15507 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15508 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15509 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511ssl_c_used : boolean
15512 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15513 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515ssl_c_verify : integer
15516 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15517 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15518 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15519 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521ssl_c_version : integer
15522 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15523 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015524
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015525ssl_f_der : binary
15526 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15527 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15528 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15529
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015530ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15532 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15533 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15534 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015535 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15537 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15538 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015539 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15540 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15541 LDAP v3.
15542 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15543 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545ssl_f_key_alg : string
15546 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15547 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15548 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550ssl_f_notafter : string
15551 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15552 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15553 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555ssl_f_notbefore : string
15556 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15557 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15558 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015559
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015560ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15562 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15563 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15564 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15565 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15566 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15567 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15568 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015569 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15570 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15571 LDAP v3.
15572 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15573 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575ssl_f_serial : binary
15576 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15577 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15578 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015579
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015580ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15581 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15582 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15583 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15586 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15587 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15588 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590ssl_f_version : integer
15591 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15592 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15593
15594ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015595 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15596 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15597 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599 Example :
15600 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15601 listen http-https
15602 bind :80
15603 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15604 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15605
15606ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15607 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15608 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15609
15610ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015611 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15613 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15614 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15615 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15616 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15617 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15618 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15619 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621ssl_fc_cipher : string
15622 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15623 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015624
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015625ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15626 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15627 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015628 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015629
15630ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15631 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15632 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015633 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015634
15635ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15636 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15637 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15638 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015639 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015640 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015641
15642ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15643 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15644 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015645 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015646
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015647ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15648 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15649 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15650 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015653 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15654 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015655 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15656 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15657 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15658 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015659
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015660ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15661 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15662 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15663 wait until the handshake happened.
15664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15666 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015667 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15668 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015669 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015670 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015671
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015672ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015673 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015674 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15675 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015678 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15680 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15681 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15682 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15683 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15684 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15685 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687ssl_fc_protocol : string
15688 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15689 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015690
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015691ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015692 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015693 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15694 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015695
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015696ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15697 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15698 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15699 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15702 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15703 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15704 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15705 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015706
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015707ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15708 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15709 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15710 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15711 BoringSSL.
15712
15713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714ssl_fc_sni : string
15715 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15716 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15717 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15718 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15719 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15720
15721 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15722 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15723 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015724 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015725 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15729 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15732 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15733 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015734
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015735
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157367.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15740sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15741only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15742For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15743be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15744can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15745sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15746for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15747content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015750 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15752 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15755 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015756 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015758
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015759req.hdrs : string
15760 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15761 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15762 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15763 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15764
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015765req.hdrs_bin : binary
15766 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15767 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15768 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15769 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15770 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15771 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15772
15773 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15774
15775 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15776 str: <int:length><bytes>
15777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778req.len : integer
15779req_len : integer (deprecated)
15780 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15781 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15782 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15783 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15784 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15785 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15786 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15787 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015789req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15790 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015791 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15792 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15793 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15794 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796 ACL alternatives :
15797 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015799req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15800 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15801 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15802 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15803 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805 ACL alternatives :
15806 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810req.proto_http : boolean
15811req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15812 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15813 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15814 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15815 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15816 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15817 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15818 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820 Example:
15821 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15822 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15823 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015824 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15827rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15828 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15829 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15830 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15831 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15832 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15833 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15834 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15837 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15838 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15839 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15840 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15841 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843 ACL derivatives :
15844 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846 Example :
15847 listen tse-farm
15848 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15849 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15850 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15851 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15852 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15853 persist rdp-cookie
15854 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15855 # This is only useful makes sense if
15856 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15857 stick-table type string size 204800
15858 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15859 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15860 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15863 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15866rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15867 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15868 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15869 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15870 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872 ACL derivatives :
15873 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015874
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015875req.ssl_alpn : string
15876 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15877 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15878 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15879 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15880 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15881 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015882 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015883
15884 Examples :
15885 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15886 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15887 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015888 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015889 default_backend bk_default
15890
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015891req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15892 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15893 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015894 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15895 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15896 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15897 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15898 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15901req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15902 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15903 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15904 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15905 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15906 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15907 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15908 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910req.ssl_sni : string
15911req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15912 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15913 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15914 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15915 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15916 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15917 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15918 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15919 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15920 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15921 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15922 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15923 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925 ACL derivatives :
15926 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928 Examples :
15929 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15930 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15931 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15932 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15933 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015934
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015935req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15936 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15937 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15938 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15939 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15940 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15941 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15942 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15943 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15944 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946req.ssl_ver : integer
15947req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15948 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15949 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15950 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15951 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15952 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15953 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15954 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015955 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015958 ACL derivatives :
15959 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015960
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015961res.len : integer
15962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15963 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15964 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15965 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15966 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15967 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15968 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15969 content inspection.
15970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15972 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015973 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15974 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15975 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15976 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15979 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15980 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15981 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15982 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015985
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015986res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15987rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15988 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15989 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15990 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15991 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15992 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15993 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15994 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996wait_end : boolean
15997 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15998 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015999 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16001 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016002 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16004 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016006 Examples :
16007 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16008 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16009 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16012 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16013 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16014 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16015 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16016 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16017 tcp-request content reject
16018
16019
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160207.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021--------------------------------------
16022
16023It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16024This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16025data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16026its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16027HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16028content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16029to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16030more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16031response are indexed.
16032
16033base : string
16034 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16035 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16036 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16037 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16038 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16039 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16040 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16041 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16042
16043 ACL derivatives :
16044 base : exact string match
16045 base_beg : prefix match
16046 base_dir : subdir match
16047 base_dom : domain match
16048 base_end : suffix match
16049 base_len : length match
16050 base_reg : regex match
16051 base_sub : substring match
16052
16053base32 : integer
16054 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16055 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16056 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016057 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16058 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16059 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060
16061base32+src : binary
16062 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16063 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16064 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16065 per-URL counters.
16066
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016067capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16068 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16069 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16070 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16071
16072capture.req.method : string
16073 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16074 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16075 because it's allocated.
16076
16077capture.req.uri : string
16078 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16079 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16080 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16081 allocated.
16082
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016083capture.req.ver : string
16084 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16085 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16086 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16087
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016088capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16089 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16090 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16091 The first entry is an index of 0.
16092 See also: "capture response header"
16093
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016094capture.res.ver : string
16095 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16096 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16097 persistent flag.
16098
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016099req.body : binary
16100 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16101 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16102 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16103 the first chunk is analyzed.
16104
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016105req.body_param([<name>) : string
16106 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16107 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16108 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16109 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16110 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16111 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16112 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16113 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16114 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16115 given.
16116
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016117req.body_len : integer
16118 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16119 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16120 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16121 "option http-buffer-request".
16122
16123req.body_size : integer
16124 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16125 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16126 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16127 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16128 "option http-buffer-request".
16129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130req.cook([<name>]) : string
16131cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16132 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16133 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16134 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16135 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16136 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16137 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16138 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16139 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16140
16141 ACL derivatives :
16142 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16143 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16144 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16145 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16146 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16147 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16148 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16149 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16152cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16153 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16154 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16157cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16158 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16159 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16160 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16161 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16164 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16165 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16166 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16167 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016168 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16170 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16171 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16172 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16175 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16176 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16177 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16178 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016179 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16182 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16183 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16184 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16185 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16186 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16187 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16188 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16189 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16192 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16193 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16194 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16195 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16198 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16199 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16200 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16201 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16202 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16203 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16204 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16205 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016206 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016207 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016208 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 ACL derivatives :
16211 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16212 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16213 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16214 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16215 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16216 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16217 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16218 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16219
16220req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16221hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16222 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16223 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16224 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16225 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16226 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16227 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16228 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16229 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16230 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16231
16232req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16233hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16234 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16235 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16236 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16237 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16238 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016239 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16241 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16242
16243req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16244hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16245 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16246 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16247 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16248 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16249 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16250 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16251 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16252
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016253
16254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16256 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16257 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16258 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16259 basic auth is supported.
16260
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016261http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16262 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16263 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16264 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16265 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16267 basic auth is supported.
16268
16269 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016270 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16271 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16272 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16273 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016275http_auth_pass : string
16276 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16277 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16278 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16279
16280http_auth_type : string
16281 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16282 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16283 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16284
16285http_auth_user : string
16286 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16287 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16288 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016290http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016291 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16292 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16294 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296method : integer + string
16297 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16298 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16299 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16300 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16301 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16302 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16303 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305 ACL derivatives :
16306 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016308 Example :
16309 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16310 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16311 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313path : string
16314 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16315 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16316 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16317 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16318 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016319 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016320 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016322 ACL derivatives :
16323 path : exact string match
16324 path_beg : prefix match
16325 path_dir : subdir match
16326 path_dom : domain match
16327 path_end : suffix match
16328 path_len : length match
16329 path_reg : regex match
16330 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016331
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016332query : string
16333 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16334 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16335 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16336 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016337 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016338 which stops before the question mark.
16339
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016340req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16341 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16342 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16343 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16344 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016346req.ver : string
16347req_ver : string (deprecated)
16348 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16349 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16350 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352 ACL derivatives :
16353 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355res.comp : boolean
16356 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16357 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16358 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360res.comp_algo : string
16361 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16362 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16363 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016365res.cook([<name>]) : string
16366scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16367 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16368 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16369 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371 ACL derivatives :
16372 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16375scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16376 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16377 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16378 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16381scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16382 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16383 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16384 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16387 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16388 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16389 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16390 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16391 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16392 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16393 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16394 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16395 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16398 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16399 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16400 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16401 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16402 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016404res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16405shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16406 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16407 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16408 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16409 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16410 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16411 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16412 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16413 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415 ACL derivatives :
16416 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16417 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16418 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16419 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16420 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16421 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16422 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16423 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16424
16425res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16426shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16427 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16428 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16429 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16430 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16431 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16434shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16435 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16436 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16437 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16438 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16439 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16440 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016441
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016442res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16443 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16444 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16445 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16446 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16449shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16450 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16451 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16452 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16453 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16454 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16455 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457res.ver : string
16458resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16459 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16460 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016462 ACL derivatives :
16463 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016465set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16466 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16467 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016468 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16472 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474status : integer
16475 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16476 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16477 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016478
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016479unique-id : string
16480 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16481 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16482 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16483 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16484 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16485 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016487url : string
16488 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16489 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16490 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16491 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16492 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16493 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16494 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496 ACL derivatives :
16497 url : exact string match
16498 url_beg : prefix match
16499 url_dir : subdir match
16500 url_dom : domain match
16501 url_end : suffix match
16502 url_len : length match
16503 url_reg : regex match
16504 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016506url_ip : ip
16507 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16508 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16509 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16510 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16511 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16512 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16513 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515url_port : integer
16516 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16517 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16518 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16519 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016520
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016521urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16522url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16524 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016525 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16526 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16527 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16528 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016529 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16530 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016531 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16532 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016534 ACL derivatives :
16535 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16536 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16537 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16538 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16539 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16540 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16541 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16542 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016543
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016545 Example :
16546 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16547 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16548 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16549 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016550
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016551urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016552 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16553 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16554 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016555
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016556url32 : integer
16557 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16558 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16559 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16560 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16561 is an unsigned integer.
16562
16563url32+src : binary
16564 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16565 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16566 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16567
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016568
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100165697.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16570---------------------------------------
16571
16572This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16573used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16574purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16575There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16576or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16577any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16578for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16579
16580internal.htx.data : integer
16581 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16582 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16583
16584internal.htx.free : integer
16585 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16586 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16587
16588internal.htx.free_data : integer
16589 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16590 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16591
16592internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16593 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16594 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16595 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16596
16597internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16598 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16599 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16600
16601internal.htx.size : integer
16602 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16603 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16604
16605internal.htx.used : integer
16606 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16607 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16608 direction.
16609
16610internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16611 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16612 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16613 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16614 of the special value :
16615 * head : The oldest inserted block
16616 * tail : The newest inserted block
16617 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16618
16619internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16620 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16621 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16622 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16623 integer or one of the special value :
16624 * head : The oldest inserted block
16625 * tail : The newest inserted block
16626 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16627
16628internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16629 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16630 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16631 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16632 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16633
16634 * head : The oldest inserted block
16635 * tail : The newest inserted block
16636 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16637
16638internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16639 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16640 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16641 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16642 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16643
16644 * head : The oldest inserted block
16645 * tail : The newest inserted block
16646 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16647
16648internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16649 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16650 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16651 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16652 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16653
16654 * head : The oldest inserted block
16655 * tail : The newest inserted block
16656 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16657
16658internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16659 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16660 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16661 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16662 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16663
16664 * head : The oldest inserted block
16665 * tail : The newest inserted block
16666 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16667
16668internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16669 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16670 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16671 it returns false.
16672
16673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166747.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016675---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016677Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16678every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016679order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016681ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16682---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016683FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016684HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016685HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16686HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016687HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16688HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16689HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16690HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16691LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016692METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016693METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016694METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16695METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16696METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16697METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016698METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016699METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016700RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016701REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016702TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016703WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16704---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016705
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167078. Logging
16708----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016709
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016710One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16711provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16712very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16713provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16714state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016715to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716headers.
16717
16718In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16719about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16720send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16721
16722 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16723 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16724 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16725 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16726 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016727 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016728 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016729
16730The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16731allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16732as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16733while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16734real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16735delay.
16736
16737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167388.1. Log levels
16739---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016740
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016741TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016742source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016743HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16744in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16745track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16746syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16747about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016748
16749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167508.2. Log formats
16751----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016752
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016753HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016754and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16755slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16756options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016757
16758 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16759 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16760 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16761 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16762 extents.
16763
16764 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16765 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16766 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16767 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16768 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16769
16770 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16771 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16772 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16773 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16774 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16775
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016776 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16777 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16778 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16779 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16780
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016781 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16782
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016783Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16784specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16785field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16786servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16787always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16788identifier.
16789
16790Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16791 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16792 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16793 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16794 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16795
16796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167978.2.1. Default log format
16798-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016799
16800This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16801as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16802format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16803
16804 Example :
16805 listen www
16806 mode http
16807 log global
16808 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16809
16810 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16811 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16812 (www/HTTP)
16813
16814 Field Format Extract from the example above
16815 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16816 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16817 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16818 4 'to' to
16819 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16820 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16821
16822Detailed fields description :
16823 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16824 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16825 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16826 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16827 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16828 and processed the connection.
16829 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16830
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016831In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16832"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16833connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16834
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016835It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16836will eventually disappear.
16837
16838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168398.2.2. TCP log format
16840---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016841
16842The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16843is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16844information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16845counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16846emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16847environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16848the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16849sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016850specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16851not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16852fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16853marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016854
16855 Example :
16856 frontend fnt
16857 mode tcp
16858 option tcplog
16859 log global
16860 default_backend bck
16861
16862 backend bck
16863 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16864
16865 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16866 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16867 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16868
16869 Field Format Extract from the example above
16870 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16871 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16872 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16873 4 frontend_name fnt
16874 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16875 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16876 7 bytes_read* 212
16877 8 termination_state --
16878 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16879 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16880
16881Detailed fields description :
16882 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016883 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16884 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16885 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016886 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016887 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016888 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016889
16890 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016891 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16892 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16893 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016894
16895 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16896 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16897 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016898 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16899 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16900 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16901 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016902
16903 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16904 and processed the connection.
16905
16906 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16907 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16908 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16909 applications.
16910
16911 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16912 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16913 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16914 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16915 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16916
16917 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16918 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16919 See "Timers" below for more details.
16920
16921 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16922 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16923 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16924 "Timers" below for more details.
16925
16926 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016927 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016928 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16929 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16930 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16931 details.
16932
16933 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16934 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16935 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16936 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16937 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16938
16939 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16940 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16941 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16942 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16943 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16944 for more details.
16945
16946 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016947 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016948 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16949 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16950 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016951 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016952
16953 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16954 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16955 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16956 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16957 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16958 caused by a denial of service attack.
16959
16960 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16961 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16962 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16963 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16964 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16965 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16966 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16967 denial of service attack.
16968
16969 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16970 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16971 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16972 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16973 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16974 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16975 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16976 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16977 be processed than on other servers.
16978
16979 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16980 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16981 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16982 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16983 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16984 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16985 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16986 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16987 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16988 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16989 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16990 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16991 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16992
16993 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16994 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16995 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16996 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16997 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16998 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016999 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017000 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17001
17002 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17003 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17004 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17005 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17006 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17007 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017008 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017009 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17010 occurs.
17011
17012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170138.2.3. HTTP log format
17014----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017015
17016The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17017is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17018the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17019are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17020emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17021generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17022"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17023which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017024frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17025is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017026
17027Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17028slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17029with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17030
17031 Example :
17032 frontend http-in
17033 mode http
17034 option httplog
17035 log global
17036 default_backend bck
17037
17038 backend static
17039 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17040
17041 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17042 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17043 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017044 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017045
17046 Field Format Extract from the example above
17047 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17048 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017049 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050 4 frontend_name http-in
17051 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017052 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017053 7 status_code 200
17054 8 bytes_read* 2750
17055 9 captured_request_cookie -
17056 10 captured_response_cookie -
17057 11 termination_state ----
17058 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17059 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17060 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17061 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17062 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017063
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017064Detailed fields description :
17065 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017066 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17067 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17068 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017069 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017070 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017071 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072
17073 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017074 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17075 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17076 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017077
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017078 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17079 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017080
17081 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17082 and processed the connection.
17083
17084 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17085 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17086 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17087
17088 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17089 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17090 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17091 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17092 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17093 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17094
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017095 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17096 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17097 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017098 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017099 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17100 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017101 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17102 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017103
17104 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17105 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017106 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017107
17108 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17109 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017110 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17111 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017112
17113 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17114 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17115 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17116 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17117 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017118 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17119 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017120
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017121 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17122 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17123 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17124 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17125 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17126 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17127 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017128 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017129
17130 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17131 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17132 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17133
17134 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17135 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017136 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017137 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17138 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17139 overflowing.
17140
17141 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17142 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17143 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17144 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17145 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17146 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17147 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17148 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17149
17150 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17151 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17152 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17153 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17154 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17155 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17156 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17157 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17158
17159 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17160 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17161 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17162 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17163 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17164 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17165 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17166
17167 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017168 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017169 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17170 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17171 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017172 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017173 system.
17174
17175 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17176 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17177 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17178 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17179 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17180 caused by a denial of service attack.
17181
17182 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17183 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17184 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17185 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17186 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17187 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17188 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17189 denial of service attack.
17190
17191 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17192 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17193 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17194 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17195 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17196 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17197 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17198 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17199 processed than on other servers.
17200
17201 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17202 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17203 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17204 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17205 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17206 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17207 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17208 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17209 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17210 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17211 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17212 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17213 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17214
17215 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17216 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17217 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17218 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17219 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17220 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017221 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017222 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17223
17224 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17225 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17226 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17227 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17228 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17229 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017230 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017231 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17232 occurs.
17233
17234 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17235 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17236 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17237 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17238 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17239 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17240 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17241 cookies" below for more details.
17242
17243 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17244 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17245 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17246 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17247 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17248 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17249 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17250 and cookies" below for more details.
17251
17252 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17253 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17254 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17255 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17256 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17257 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17258 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17259 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17260
17261
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200172628.2.4. Custom log format
17263------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017264
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017265The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017266mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017267
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017268HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017269Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17270separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17271prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17272
17273Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17274variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017275("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017276
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017277If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017278as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017279less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17280the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17281
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017282Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017283In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017284in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017285
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017286Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17287'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17288https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17289such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17290
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017291Flags are :
17292 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017293 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017294 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17295 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017296
17297 Example:
17298
17299 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17300 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17301
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017302 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17303
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017304At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17305
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017306 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17307 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017308
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017309the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017310
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017311 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17312 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17313 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017314
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017315and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17316
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017317 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17318 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017319
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017320Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17321
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017322 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017323 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017324 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17325 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17326 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017327 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17328 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17329 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017330 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017331 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17332 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017333 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017334 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17335 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017336 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017337 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017338 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017339 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017340 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017341 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017342 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017343 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17344 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17345 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17346 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17347 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017348 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017349 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17350 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017351 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017352 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17353 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017354 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17355 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17356 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017357 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017358 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17359 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017360 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017361 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17362 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17363 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017364 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017365 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017366 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17367 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17368 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17369 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017370 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017371 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017372 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017373 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017374 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017375 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017376 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17377 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17378 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017379 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017380 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17381 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017382 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017383 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17384 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017385 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017386 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017387 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017388 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017389
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017390 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017391
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017392
173938.2.5. Error log format
17394-----------------------
17395
17396When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17397protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17398By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17399"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017400will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017401logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17402
17403The format looks like this :
17404
17405 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17406 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17407 Connection error during SSL handshake
17408
17409 Field Format Extract from the example above
17410 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17411 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17412 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17413 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17414 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17415
17416These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17417failures.
17418
17419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174208.3. Advanced logging options
17421-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017422
17423Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17424just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17425options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17426for more information about their usage.
17427
17428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174298.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17430------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017431
17432It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17433haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17434commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17435monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17436ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17437
17438 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17439 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17440 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17441 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17442
17443 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17444 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17445 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017446 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017447 such as other load-balancers.
17448
17449 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17450 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17451 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17452
17453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174548.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17455----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017456
17457The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17458what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17459or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017460"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017461just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17462log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17463after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17464is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17465with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17466with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17467
17468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174698.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17470------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017471
17472Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17473for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17474"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17475retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17476raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17477a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17478file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17479you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17480"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17481
17482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17484--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017485
17486Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17487multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17488them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17489"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17490logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17491error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17492and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17493too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17494useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17495alternative.
17496
17497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174988.4. Timing events
17499------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017500
17501Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17502reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17503the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17504frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017505mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17506addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17507
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017508Timings events in HTTP mode:
17509
17510 first request 2nd request
17511 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17512 t tr t tr ...
17513 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17514 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17515 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17516 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17517 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17518
17519Timings events in TCP mode:
17520
17521 TCP session
17522 |<----------------->|
17523 t t
17524 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17525 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17526 |<------ Tt ------->|
17527
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017528 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017529 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017530 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17531 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17532 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017533 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017534 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17535 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17536 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17537 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017538
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017539 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17540 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17541 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017542 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17543 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17544 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17545 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17546 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17547 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017548
17549 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17550 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17551 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17552 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17553 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17554 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17555 request typed by hand during a test.
17556
17557 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17558 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017559 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017560 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17561 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17562 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17563 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017564
17565 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17566 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17567 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17568 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17569 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17570
17571 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17572 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17573 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17574 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17575 connection never established.
17576
17577 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17578 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17579 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17580 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17581 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17582 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17583 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17584 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17585 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17586 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17587 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17588
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017589 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17590 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17591 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17592 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17593 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17594 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17595
17596 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17597
17598 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17599 "Ta" can never be negative.
17600
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017601 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17602 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017603 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17604 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017605 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017606
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017607 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017608
17609 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017610 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17611 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017612
17613These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17614protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17615that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017616due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17617"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17618that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017619
17620Most common cases :
17621
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017622 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17623 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17624 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17625 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17626 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17627 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17628 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17629 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17630 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17631 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17632 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017633 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634
17635 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17636 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17637 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17638 of ms on remote networks.
17639
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017640 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17641 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17642 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017644 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17645 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17646 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17647 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17648 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17649 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17650 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17651 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17652 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017653
17654Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17655
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017656 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017657 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017658 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017659
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017660 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017661 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17662 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17663
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017664 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017665 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17666 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17667 flags.
17668
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017669 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17670 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017671 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17672 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17673 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17674 the client connection was maintained open.
17675
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017676 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017677 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017678 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017679 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17680
17681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176828.5. Session state at disconnection
17683-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017684
17685TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17686"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
176872-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17688each of which has a special meaning :
17689
17690 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17691 session to terminate :
17692
17693 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17694
17695 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17696 server explicitly refused it.
17697
17698 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17699 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17700 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17701 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017702 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017703
17704 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17705 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706
17707 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17708 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17709 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17710 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17711 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17712
17713 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17714 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17715 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17716 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17717 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17718
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017719 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17720 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17721
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017722 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17723 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17724 backup connections when going up.
17725
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017726 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17729 send or receive data.
17730
17731 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17732 send or receive data.
17733
17734 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17735 with nothing left in the buffers.
17736
17737 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17738
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017739 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017740 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17741
17742 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17743 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17744 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17745 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17746 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17747
17748 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17749 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17750
17751 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17752 server (HTTP only).
17753
17754 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17755
17756 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17757 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17758 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17759
17760 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17761 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17762 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17763
17764 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17765
17766 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17767 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17768
17769 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17770 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17771 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17772
17773 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17774 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017775 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17776 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017777
17778 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17779 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17780 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17781 another server.
17782
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017783 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017784 server.
17785
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017786 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17787 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17788 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17789 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17790
17791 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17792 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17793 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17794 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17795
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017796 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17797 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17798 "use-server" rule).
17799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17801
17802 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17803 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17804
17805 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17806
17807 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17808 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17809 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17810
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017811 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17812 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017813 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017814 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17815 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17816
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017817 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17818
17819 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17820 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17821
17822 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17823
17824 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17825
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017826The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17827was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17829starvation, attacks, etc...
17830
17831The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17832alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17833easier finding and understanding.
17834
17835 Flags Reason
17836
17837 -- Normal termination.
17838
17839 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17840 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17841 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17842 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17843
17844 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17845 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17846 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17847 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17848 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17849 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017850
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017851 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17852 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017853 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017854
17855 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17856 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17857 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17858
17859 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17860 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17861 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17862 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17863 the server takes too long to respond.
17864
17865 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17866 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17867 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17868 long a time to respond.
17869
17870 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17871 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17872 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17873 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017874 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17875 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876
17877 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17878 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17879 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17880 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17881 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017882 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017883 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17884 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17885 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17886 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17887 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17888 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17889 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17890 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017891 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017892 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17893 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17894 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017895
17896 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17897 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017898 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17899 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17900 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17901 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017902
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017903 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17904 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017906 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017907 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17908 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017909 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017910 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17911 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17912
17913 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17914 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17915 503 or 504 here.
17916
17917 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17918 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17919 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17920 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17921 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17922
17923 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17924 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017925 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17927 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17928
17929 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17930 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17931 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17932 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17933 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17934 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17935 between haproxy and the server.
17936
17937 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17938 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17939 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17940 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17941 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17942 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17943 solution is to fix the application.
17944
17945 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17946 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17947 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17948 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17949 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17950 external attacks.
17951
17952 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17953 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017954 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017955 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17956 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17957
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017958 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17959 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17960 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017961 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017962 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017963
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017964 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17965 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17966 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17967 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017968 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17969 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17970 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17971 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17972 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017973
17974 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17975 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17976 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17977 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17978
17979 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17980 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17981 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17982 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17983
17984 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17985 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17986 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17987 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17988
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017989The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17990persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17991important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17992re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17993
17994 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17995
17996 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17997 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17998 set on a GET request.
17999
18000 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18001 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018002 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018003 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18004
18005 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18006 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18007 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18008
18009 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18010 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18011 already got a cookie.
18012
18013 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18014 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18015 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18016 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18017 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18018
18019 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18020 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18021 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18022
18023 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18024 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18025 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18026
18027 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18028 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18029
18030 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18031 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18032 then advertised in the response.
18033
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180358.6. Non-printable characters
18036-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018037
18038In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18039consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18040converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18041prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18042being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18043escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18044is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18045'}' when logging headers.
18046
18047Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18048issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18049containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18050
18051Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18052the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18053performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18054
18055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180568.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18057---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018058
18059Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18060achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018061section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018062cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18063the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18064the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018065locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018066not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18067user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18068a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18069wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18070
18071 Examples :
18072 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18073 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18074
18075 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18076 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18077
18078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180798.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18080---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018081
18082Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18083proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18084the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18085server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18086
18087Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18088response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018089section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018090
18091It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018092time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18093appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018094are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18095and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18096follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18097request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18098in the logs.
18099
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018100As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18101frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18102an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18103
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018104 Example :
18105 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18106 listen proxy-out
18107 mode http
18108 option httplog
18109 option logasap
18110 log global
18111 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18112
18113 # log the name of the virtual server
18114 capture request header Host len 20
18115
18116 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18117 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18118
18119 # log the beginning of the referrer
18120 capture request header Referer len 20
18121
18122 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18123 capture response header Server len 20
18124
18125 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18126 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18127
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018128 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018129 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18130
18131 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18132 capture response header Via len 20
18133
18134 # log the URL location during a redirection
18135 capture response header Location len 20
18136
18137 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18138 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18139 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18140 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18141 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18142
18143 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18144 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18145 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18146 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018147 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018148
18149 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18150 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18151 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18152 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18153 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018154 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018155
18156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181578.9. Examples of logs
18158---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018159
18160These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18161them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18162reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18163
18164 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18165 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18166 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18167
18168 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18169 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18170
18171 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18172 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18173 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18174
18175 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18176 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18177
18178 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18179 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18180 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18181
18182 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018183 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018184 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18185 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18186
18187 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18188 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18189 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18190
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018191 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18192 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18193 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18194 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18195 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18196 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018197
18198 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018199 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018200
18201 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18202 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18203 Nothing was sent to any server.
18204
18205 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18206 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18207
18208 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18209 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018210 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018211 send a 408 return code to the client.
18212
18213 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18214 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18215
18216 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18217 5 seconds ("c----").
18218
18219 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18220 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018221 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018222
18223 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018224 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018225 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18226 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18227 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18228 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18229 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018230
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018231
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200182329. Supported filters
18233--------------------
18234
18235Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18236accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18237unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18238
18239See also : "filter"
18240
182419.1. Trace
18242----------
18243
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018244filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018245
18246 Arguments:
18247 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18248 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18249
18250 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18251 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18252 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18253 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18254
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018255 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018256 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18257 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18258 amount of the parsed data.
18259
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018260 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018261
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018262This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18263callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18264information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18265filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18266
18267Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18268tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18269a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18270
18271
182729.2. HTTP compression
18273---------------------
18274
18275filter compression
18276
18277The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18278keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018279when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18280fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18281done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18282explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18283filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18284listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18285order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018286
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018287See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18288 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018289
18290
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200182919.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18292--------------------------------------------
18293
18294filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18295
18296 Arguments :
18297
18298 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18299 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18300 parsed.
18301
18302 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18303 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18304 part must be placed in its own scope.
18305
18306The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18307external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018308streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018309exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18310also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18311
18312SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18313the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18314
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018315For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018316"doc/SPOE.txt".
18317
18318Important note:
18319 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18320 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18321
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100183229.4. Cache
18323----------
18324
18325filter cache <name>
18326
18327 Arguments :
18328
18329 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18330
18331The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18332"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018333cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018334other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18335case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18336is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18337filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018338listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18339order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018340
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018341See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18342 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18343
18344
183459.5. Fcgi-app
18346-------------
18347
18348filter fcg-app <name>
18349
18350 Arguments :
18351
18352 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18353
18354The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18355request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18356reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18357used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18358implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18359used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18360fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18361used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18362order.
18363
18364See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18365 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18366
18367
1836810. FastCGI applications
18369-------------------------
18370
18371HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18372feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18373the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18374FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18375servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18376FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18377backend.
18378
18379HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18380application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18381connection.
18382
1838310.1. Setup
18384-----------
18385
1838610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18387--------------------------
18388
18389fcgi-app <name>
18390 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18391 document root must be defined.
18392
18393acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18394 Declare or complete an access list.
18395
18396 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18397 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18398 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18399 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18400 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18401
18402docroot <path>
18403 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18404 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18405 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18406
18407index <script-name>
18408 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18409 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18410 is an optional setting.
18411
18412 Example :
18413 index index.php
18414
18415log-stderr global
18416log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18417 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18418 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18419
18420 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18421 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18422
18423pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18424 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18425 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18426 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18427
18428 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18429 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18430 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18431 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18432
18433 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18434 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18435
18436path-info <regex>
18437 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18438 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18439 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18440 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18441 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18442
18443 Example :
18444 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18445
18446option get-values
18447no option get-values
18448 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18449
18450 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18451 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18452
18453 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18454 application will accept.
18455
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018456 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18457 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018458
18459 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18460 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18461 option is disabled.
18462
18463 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18464 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18465 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18466 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18467 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18468 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18469
18470option keep-conn
18471no option keep-conn
18472 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18473 sending a response.
18474
18475 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18476 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18477
18478option max-reqs <reqs>
18479 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18480 accept.
18481
18482 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18483 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18484 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18485 to 1.
18486
18487option mpxs-conns
18488no option mpxs-conns
18489 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18490
18491 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18492 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18493
18494set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18495 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18496 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18497 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18498 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18499
18500 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18501 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18502 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18503
18504 Example :
18505 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18506 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18507
18508 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18509
18510
1851110.1.2. Proxy section
18512---------------------
18513
18514use-fcgi-app <name>
18515 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18516
18517 Arguments :
18518 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18519
18520 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18521 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18522 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18523 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18524 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18525
18526 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18527 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18528 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18529 application are evaluated.
18530
18531
1853210.1.3. Example
18533---------------
18534
18535 frontend front-http
18536 mode http
18537 bind *:80
18538 bind *:
18539
18540 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18541 default_backend back-static
18542
18543 backend back-static
18544 mode http
18545 server www A.B.C.D:80
18546
18547 backend back-dynamic
18548 mode http
18549 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18550 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18551
18552 fcgi-app php-fpm
18553 log-stderr global
18554 option keep-conn
18555
18556 docroot /var/www/my-app
18557 index index.php
18558 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18559
18560
1856110.2. Default parameters
18562------------------------
18563
18564A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18565the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18566scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18567applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18568
18569 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18570 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18571 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18572 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18573 | | |
18574 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18575 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18576 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18577 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18578 | | application. |
18579 | | |
18580 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18581 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18582 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18583 | | |
18584 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18585 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18586 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18587 | | the application's configuration. |
18588 | | |
18589 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18590 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18591 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18592 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18593 | | |
18594 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18595 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18596 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18597 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18598 | | be defined. |
18599 | | |
18600 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18601 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18602 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18603 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18604 | | is not set too. |
18605 | | |
18606 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18607 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18608 | | set. |
18609 | | |
18610 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18611 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18612 | | the request. |
18613 | | |
18614 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18615 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18616 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18617 | | |
18618 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18619 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18620 | | script to process the request. |
18621 | | |
18622 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18623 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18624 | | |
18625 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18626 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18627 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18628 | | |
18629 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18630 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18631 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18632 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18633 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18634 | | |
18635 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18636 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18637 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18638 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18639 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18640 | | side. |
18641 | | |
18642 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18643 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18644 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18645 | | connected to. |
18646 | | |
18647 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18648 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18649 | | |
18650 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18651 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18652 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18653 | | |
18654 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18655
18656
1865710.3. Limitations
18658------------------
18659
18660The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18661way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18662during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18663establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18664application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18665or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18666message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18667these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18668and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18669
18670Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18671request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18672requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18673
18674About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18675into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18676fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18677"http-request" ones.
18678
18679Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18680FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18681processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18682must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18683here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018685/*
18686 * Local variables:
18687 * fill-column: 79
18688 * End:
18689 */